* symtab.h (enum address_class): Remove LOC_REGPARM and
[binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / ada-lang.c
1 /* Ada language support routines for GDB, the GNU debugger. Copyright (C)
2
3 1992, 1993, 1994, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2007
4 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5
6 This file is part of GDB.
7
8 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
9 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
10 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
11 (at your option) any later version.
12
13 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
14 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
15 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
16 GNU General Public License for more details.
17
18 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
19 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20
21
22 #include "defs.h"
23 #include <stdio.h>
24 #include "gdb_string.h"
25 #include <ctype.h>
26 #include <stdarg.h>
27 #include "demangle.h"
28 #include "gdb_regex.h"
29 #include "frame.h"
30 #include "symtab.h"
31 #include "gdbtypes.h"
32 #include "gdbcmd.h"
33 #include "expression.h"
34 #include "parser-defs.h"
35 #include "language.h"
36 #include "c-lang.h"
37 #include "inferior.h"
38 #include "symfile.h"
39 #include "objfiles.h"
40 #include "breakpoint.h"
41 #include "gdbcore.h"
42 #include "hashtab.h"
43 #include "gdb_obstack.h"
44 #include "ada-lang.h"
45 #include "completer.h"
46 #include "gdb_stat.h"
47 #ifdef UI_OUT
48 #include "ui-out.h"
49 #endif
50 #include "block.h"
51 #include "infcall.h"
52 #include "dictionary.h"
53 #include "exceptions.h"
54 #include "annotate.h"
55 #include "valprint.h"
56 #include "source.h"
57 #include "observer.h"
58 #include "vec.h"
59
60 #ifndef ADA_RETAIN_DOTS
61 #define ADA_RETAIN_DOTS 0
62 #endif
63
64 /* Define whether or not the C operator '/' truncates towards zero for
65 differently signed operands (truncation direction is undefined in C).
66 Copied from valarith.c. */
67
68 #ifndef TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO
69 #define TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO ((-5 / 2) == -2)
70 #endif
71
72 static void extract_string (CORE_ADDR addr, char *buf);
73
74 static void modify_general_field (char *, LONGEST, int, int);
75
76 static struct type *desc_base_type (struct type *);
77
78 static struct type *desc_bounds_type (struct type *);
79
80 static struct value *desc_bounds (struct value *);
81
82 static int fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (struct type *);
83
84 static int fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (struct type *);
85
86 static struct type *desc_data_type (struct type *);
87
88 static struct value *desc_data (struct value *);
89
90 static int fat_pntr_data_bitpos (struct type *);
91
92 static int fat_pntr_data_bitsize (struct type *);
93
94 static struct value *desc_one_bound (struct value *, int, int);
95
96 static int desc_bound_bitpos (struct type *, int, int);
97
98 static int desc_bound_bitsize (struct type *, int, int);
99
100 static struct type *desc_index_type (struct type *, int);
101
102 static int desc_arity (struct type *);
103
104 static int ada_type_match (struct type *, struct type *, int);
105
106 static int ada_args_match (struct symbol *, struct value **, int);
107
108 static struct value *ensure_lval (struct value *, CORE_ADDR *);
109
110 static struct value *convert_actual (struct value *, struct type *,
111 CORE_ADDR *);
112
113 static struct value *make_array_descriptor (struct type *, struct value *,
114 CORE_ADDR *);
115
116 static void ada_add_block_symbols (struct obstack *,
117 struct block *, const char *,
118 domain_enum, struct objfile *, int);
119
120 static int is_nonfunction (struct ada_symbol_info *, int);
121
122 static void add_defn_to_vec (struct obstack *, struct symbol *,
123 struct block *);
124
125 static int num_defns_collected (struct obstack *);
126
127 static struct ada_symbol_info *defns_collected (struct obstack *, int);
128
129 static struct partial_symbol *ada_lookup_partial_symbol (struct partial_symtab
130 *, const char *, int,
131 domain_enum, int);
132
133 static struct symtab *symtab_for_sym (struct symbol *);
134
135 static struct value *resolve_subexp (struct expression **, int *, int,
136 struct type *);
137
138 static void replace_operator_with_call (struct expression **, int, int, int,
139 struct symbol *, struct block *);
140
141 static int possible_user_operator_p (enum exp_opcode, struct value **);
142
143 static char *ada_op_name (enum exp_opcode);
144
145 static const char *ada_decoded_op_name (enum exp_opcode);
146
147 static int numeric_type_p (struct type *);
148
149 static int integer_type_p (struct type *);
150
151 static int scalar_type_p (struct type *);
152
153 static int discrete_type_p (struct type *);
154
155 static enum ada_renaming_category parse_old_style_renaming (struct type *,
156 const char **,
157 int *,
158 const char **);
159
160 static struct symbol *find_old_style_renaming_symbol (const char *,
161 struct block *);
162
163 static struct type *ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (struct type *, char *,
164 int, int, int *);
165
166 static struct value *evaluate_subexp (struct type *, struct expression *,
167 int *, enum noside);
168
169 static struct value *evaluate_subexp_type (struct expression *, int *);
170
171 static int is_dynamic_field (struct type *, int);
172
173 static struct type *to_fixed_variant_branch_type (struct type *,
174 const gdb_byte *,
175 CORE_ADDR, struct value *);
176
177 static struct type *to_fixed_array_type (struct type *, struct value *, int);
178
179 static struct type *to_fixed_range_type (char *, struct value *,
180 struct objfile *);
181
182 static struct type *to_static_fixed_type (struct type *);
183 static struct type *static_unwrap_type (struct type *type);
184
185 static struct value *unwrap_value (struct value *);
186
187 static struct type *packed_array_type (struct type *, long *);
188
189 static struct type *decode_packed_array_type (struct type *);
190
191 static struct value *decode_packed_array (struct value *);
192
193 static struct value *value_subscript_packed (struct value *, int,
194 struct value **);
195
196 static void move_bits (gdb_byte *, int, const gdb_byte *, int, int);
197
198 static struct value *coerce_unspec_val_to_type (struct value *,
199 struct type *);
200
201 static struct value *get_var_value (char *, char *);
202
203 static int lesseq_defined_than (struct symbol *, struct symbol *);
204
205 static int equiv_types (struct type *, struct type *);
206
207 static int is_name_suffix (const char *);
208
209 static int wild_match (const char *, int, const char *);
210
211 static struct value *ada_coerce_ref (struct value *);
212
213 static LONGEST pos_atr (struct value *);
214
215 static struct value *value_pos_atr (struct value *);
216
217 static struct value *value_val_atr (struct type *, struct value *);
218
219 static struct symbol *standard_lookup (const char *, const struct block *,
220 domain_enum);
221
222 static struct value *ada_search_struct_field (char *, struct value *, int,
223 struct type *);
224
225 static struct value *ada_value_primitive_field (struct value *, int, int,
226 struct type *);
227
228 static int find_struct_field (char *, struct type *, int,
229 struct type **, int *, int *, int *, int *);
230
231 static struct value *ada_to_fixed_value_create (struct type *, CORE_ADDR,
232 struct value *);
233
234 static struct value *ada_to_fixed_value (struct value *);
235
236 static int ada_resolve_function (struct ada_symbol_info *, int,
237 struct value **, int, const char *,
238 struct type *);
239
240 static struct value *ada_coerce_to_simple_array (struct value *);
241
242 static int ada_is_direct_array_type (struct type *);
243
244 static void ada_language_arch_info (struct gdbarch *,
245 struct language_arch_info *);
246
247 static void check_size (const struct type *);
248
249 static struct value *ada_index_struct_field (int, struct value *, int,
250 struct type *);
251
252 static struct value *assign_aggregate (struct value *, struct value *,
253 struct expression *, int *, enum noside);
254
255 static void aggregate_assign_from_choices (struct value *, struct value *,
256 struct expression *,
257 int *, LONGEST *, int *,
258 int, LONGEST, LONGEST);
259
260 static void aggregate_assign_positional (struct value *, struct value *,
261 struct expression *,
262 int *, LONGEST *, int *, int,
263 LONGEST, LONGEST);
264
265
266 static void aggregate_assign_others (struct value *, struct value *,
267 struct expression *,
268 int *, LONGEST *, int, LONGEST, LONGEST);
269
270
271 static void add_component_interval (LONGEST, LONGEST, LONGEST *, int *, int);
272
273
274 static struct value *ada_evaluate_subexp (struct type *, struct expression *,
275 int *, enum noside);
276
277 static void ada_forward_operator_length (struct expression *, int, int *,
278 int *);
279 \f
280
281
282 /* Maximum-sized dynamic type. */
283 static unsigned int varsize_limit;
284
285 /* FIXME: brobecker/2003-09-17: No longer a const because it is
286 returned by a function that does not return a const char *. */
287 static char *ada_completer_word_break_characters =
288 #ifdef VMS
289 " \t\n!@#%^&*()+=|~`}{[]\";:?/,-";
290 #else
291 " \t\n!@#$%^&*()+=|~`}{[]\";:?/,-";
292 #endif
293
294 /* The name of the symbol to use to get the name of the main subprogram. */
295 static const char ADA_MAIN_PROGRAM_SYMBOL_NAME[]
296 = "__gnat_ada_main_program_name";
297
298 /* Limit on the number of warnings to raise per expression evaluation. */
299 static int warning_limit = 2;
300
301 /* Number of warning messages issued; reset to 0 by cleanups after
302 expression evaluation. */
303 static int warnings_issued = 0;
304
305 static const char *known_runtime_file_name_patterns[] = {
306 ADA_KNOWN_RUNTIME_FILE_NAME_PATTERNS NULL
307 };
308
309 static const char *known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[] = {
310 ADA_KNOWN_AUXILIARY_FUNCTION_NAME_PATTERNS NULL
311 };
312
313 /* Space for allocating results of ada_lookup_symbol_list. */
314 static struct obstack symbol_list_obstack;
315
316 /* Utilities */
317
318 /* Given DECODED_NAME a string holding a symbol name in its
319 decoded form (ie using the Ada dotted notation), returns
320 its unqualified name. */
321
322 static const char *
323 ada_unqualified_name (const char *decoded_name)
324 {
325 const char *result = strrchr (decoded_name, '.');
326
327 if (result != NULL)
328 result++; /* Skip the dot... */
329 else
330 result = decoded_name;
331
332 return result;
333 }
334
335 /* Return a string starting with '<', followed by STR, and '>'.
336 The result is good until the next call. */
337
338 static char *
339 add_angle_brackets (const char *str)
340 {
341 static char *result = NULL;
342
343 xfree (result);
344 result = (char *) xmalloc ((strlen (str) + 3) * sizeof (char));
345
346 sprintf (result, "<%s>", str);
347 return result;
348 }
349
350 static char *
351 ada_get_gdb_completer_word_break_characters (void)
352 {
353 return ada_completer_word_break_characters;
354 }
355
356 /* Print an array element index using the Ada syntax. */
357
358 static void
359 ada_print_array_index (struct value *index_value, struct ui_file *stream,
360 int format, enum val_prettyprint pretty)
361 {
362 LA_VALUE_PRINT (index_value, stream, format, pretty);
363 fprintf_filtered (stream, " => ");
364 }
365
366 /* Read the string located at ADDR from the inferior and store the
367 result into BUF. */
368
369 static void
370 extract_string (CORE_ADDR addr, char *buf)
371 {
372 int char_index = 0;
373
374 /* Loop, reading one byte at a time, until we reach the '\000'
375 end-of-string marker. */
376 do
377 {
378 target_read_memory (addr + char_index * sizeof (char),
379 buf + char_index * sizeof (char), sizeof (char));
380 char_index++;
381 }
382 while (buf[char_index - 1] != '\000');
383 }
384
385 /* Assuming VECT points to an array of *SIZE objects of size
386 ELEMENT_SIZE, grow it to contain at least MIN_SIZE objects,
387 updating *SIZE as necessary and returning the (new) array. */
388
389 void *
390 grow_vect (void *vect, size_t *size, size_t min_size, int element_size)
391 {
392 if (*size < min_size)
393 {
394 *size *= 2;
395 if (*size < min_size)
396 *size = min_size;
397 vect = xrealloc (vect, *size * element_size);
398 }
399 return vect;
400 }
401
402 /* True (non-zero) iff TARGET matches FIELD_NAME up to any trailing
403 suffix of FIELD_NAME beginning "___". */
404
405 static int
406 field_name_match (const char *field_name, const char *target)
407 {
408 int len = strlen (target);
409 return
410 (strncmp (field_name, target, len) == 0
411 && (field_name[len] == '\0'
412 || (strncmp (field_name + len, "___", 3) == 0
413 && strcmp (field_name + strlen (field_name) - 6,
414 "___XVN") != 0)));
415 }
416
417
418 /* Assuming TYPE is a TYPE_CODE_STRUCT, find the field whose name matches
419 FIELD_NAME, and return its index. This function also handles fields
420 whose name have ___ suffixes because the compiler sometimes alters
421 their name by adding such a suffix to represent fields with certain
422 constraints. If the field could not be found, return a negative
423 number if MAYBE_MISSING is set. Otherwise raise an error. */
424
425 int
426 ada_get_field_index (const struct type *type, const char *field_name,
427 int maybe_missing)
428 {
429 int fieldno;
430 for (fieldno = 0; fieldno < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); fieldno++)
431 if (field_name_match (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, fieldno), field_name))
432 return fieldno;
433
434 if (!maybe_missing)
435 error (_("Unable to find field %s in struct %s. Aborting"),
436 field_name, TYPE_NAME (type));
437
438 return -1;
439 }
440
441 /* The length of the prefix of NAME prior to any "___" suffix. */
442
443 int
444 ada_name_prefix_len (const char *name)
445 {
446 if (name == NULL)
447 return 0;
448 else
449 {
450 const char *p = strstr (name, "___");
451 if (p == NULL)
452 return strlen (name);
453 else
454 return p - name;
455 }
456 }
457
458 /* Return non-zero if SUFFIX is a suffix of STR.
459 Return zero if STR is null. */
460
461 static int
462 is_suffix (const char *str, const char *suffix)
463 {
464 int len1, len2;
465 if (str == NULL)
466 return 0;
467 len1 = strlen (str);
468 len2 = strlen (suffix);
469 return (len1 >= len2 && strcmp (str + len1 - len2, suffix) == 0);
470 }
471
472 /* Create a value of type TYPE whose contents come from VALADDR, if it
473 is non-null, and whose memory address (in the inferior) is
474 ADDRESS. */
475
476 struct value *
477 value_from_contents_and_address (struct type *type,
478 const gdb_byte *valaddr,
479 CORE_ADDR address)
480 {
481 struct value *v = allocate_value (type);
482 if (valaddr == NULL)
483 set_value_lazy (v, 1);
484 else
485 memcpy (value_contents_raw (v), valaddr, TYPE_LENGTH (type));
486 VALUE_ADDRESS (v) = address;
487 if (address != 0)
488 VALUE_LVAL (v) = lval_memory;
489 return v;
490 }
491
492 /* The contents of value VAL, treated as a value of type TYPE. The
493 result is an lval in memory if VAL is. */
494
495 static struct value *
496 coerce_unspec_val_to_type (struct value *val, struct type *type)
497 {
498 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
499 if (value_type (val) == type)
500 return val;
501 else
502 {
503 struct value *result;
504
505 /* Make sure that the object size is not unreasonable before
506 trying to allocate some memory for it. */
507 check_size (type);
508
509 result = allocate_value (type);
510 VALUE_LVAL (result) = VALUE_LVAL (val);
511 set_value_bitsize (result, value_bitsize (val));
512 set_value_bitpos (result, value_bitpos (val));
513 VALUE_ADDRESS (result) = VALUE_ADDRESS (val) + value_offset (val);
514 if (value_lazy (val)
515 || TYPE_LENGTH (type) > TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (val)))
516 set_value_lazy (result, 1);
517 else
518 memcpy (value_contents_raw (result), value_contents (val),
519 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
520 return result;
521 }
522 }
523
524 static const gdb_byte *
525 cond_offset_host (const gdb_byte *valaddr, long offset)
526 {
527 if (valaddr == NULL)
528 return NULL;
529 else
530 return valaddr + offset;
531 }
532
533 static CORE_ADDR
534 cond_offset_target (CORE_ADDR address, long offset)
535 {
536 if (address == 0)
537 return 0;
538 else
539 return address + offset;
540 }
541
542 /* Issue a warning (as for the definition of warning in utils.c, but
543 with exactly one argument rather than ...), unless the limit on the
544 number of warnings has passed during the evaluation of the current
545 expression. */
546
547 /* FIXME: cagney/2004-10-10: This function is mimicking the behavior
548 provided by "complaint". */
549 static void lim_warning (const char *format, ...) ATTR_FORMAT (printf, 1, 2);
550
551 static void
552 lim_warning (const char *format, ...)
553 {
554 va_list args;
555 va_start (args, format);
556
557 warnings_issued += 1;
558 if (warnings_issued <= warning_limit)
559 vwarning (format, args);
560
561 va_end (args);
562 }
563
564 /* Issue an error if the size of an object of type T is unreasonable,
565 i.e. if it would be a bad idea to allocate a value of this type in
566 GDB. */
567
568 static void
569 check_size (const struct type *type)
570 {
571 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type) > varsize_limit)
572 error (_("object size is larger than varsize-limit"));
573 }
574
575
576 /* Note: would have used MAX_OF_TYPE and MIN_OF_TYPE macros from
577 gdbtypes.h, but some of the necessary definitions in that file
578 seem to have gone missing. */
579
580 /* Maximum value of a SIZE-byte signed integer type. */
581 static LONGEST
582 max_of_size (int size)
583 {
584 LONGEST top_bit = (LONGEST) 1 << (size * 8 - 2);
585 return top_bit | (top_bit - 1);
586 }
587
588 /* Minimum value of a SIZE-byte signed integer type. */
589 static LONGEST
590 min_of_size (int size)
591 {
592 return -max_of_size (size) - 1;
593 }
594
595 /* Maximum value of a SIZE-byte unsigned integer type. */
596 static ULONGEST
597 umax_of_size (int size)
598 {
599 ULONGEST top_bit = (ULONGEST) 1 << (size * 8 - 1);
600 return top_bit | (top_bit - 1);
601 }
602
603 /* Maximum value of integral type T, as a signed quantity. */
604 static LONGEST
605 max_of_type (struct type *t)
606 {
607 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (t))
608 return (LONGEST) umax_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t));
609 else
610 return max_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t));
611 }
612
613 /* Minimum value of integral type T, as a signed quantity. */
614 static LONGEST
615 min_of_type (struct type *t)
616 {
617 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (t))
618 return 0;
619 else
620 return min_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t));
621 }
622
623 /* The largest value in the domain of TYPE, a discrete type, as an integer. */
624 static struct value *
625 discrete_type_high_bound (struct type *type)
626 {
627 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
628 {
629 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
630 return value_from_longest (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type),
631 TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type));
632 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
633 return
634 value_from_longest (type,
635 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type,
636 TYPE_NFIELDS (type) - 1));
637 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
638 return value_from_longest (type, max_of_type (type));
639 default:
640 error (_("Unexpected type in discrete_type_high_bound."));
641 }
642 }
643
644 /* The largest value in the domain of TYPE, a discrete type, as an integer. */
645 static struct value *
646 discrete_type_low_bound (struct type *type)
647 {
648 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
649 {
650 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
651 return value_from_longest (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type),
652 TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type));
653 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
654 return value_from_longest (type, TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, 0));
655 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
656 return value_from_longest (type, min_of_type (type));
657 default:
658 error (_("Unexpected type in discrete_type_low_bound."));
659 }
660 }
661
662 /* The identity on non-range types. For range types, the underlying
663 non-range scalar type. */
664
665 static struct type *
666 base_type (struct type *type)
667 {
668 while (type != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
669 {
670 if (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) || TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) == NULL)
671 return type;
672 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
673 }
674 return type;
675 }
676 \f
677
678 /* Language Selection */
679
680 /* If the main program is in Ada, return language_ada, otherwise return LANG
681 (the main program is in Ada iif the adainit symbol is found).
682
683 MAIN_PST is not used. */
684
685 enum language
686 ada_update_initial_language (enum language lang,
687 struct partial_symtab *main_pst)
688 {
689 if (lookup_minimal_symbol ("adainit", (const char *) NULL,
690 (struct objfile *) NULL) != NULL)
691 return language_ada;
692
693 return lang;
694 }
695
696 /* If the main procedure is written in Ada, then return its name.
697 The result is good until the next call. Return NULL if the main
698 procedure doesn't appear to be in Ada. */
699
700 char *
701 ada_main_name (void)
702 {
703 struct minimal_symbol *msym;
704 CORE_ADDR main_program_name_addr;
705 static char main_program_name[1024];
706
707 /* For Ada, the name of the main procedure is stored in a specific
708 string constant, generated by the binder. Look for that symbol,
709 extract its address, and then read that string. If we didn't find
710 that string, then most probably the main procedure is not written
711 in Ada. */
712 msym = lookup_minimal_symbol (ADA_MAIN_PROGRAM_SYMBOL_NAME, NULL, NULL);
713
714 if (msym != NULL)
715 {
716 main_program_name_addr = SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (msym);
717 if (main_program_name_addr == 0)
718 error (_("Invalid address for Ada main program name."));
719
720 extract_string (main_program_name_addr, main_program_name);
721 return main_program_name;
722 }
723
724 /* The main procedure doesn't seem to be in Ada. */
725 return NULL;
726 }
727 \f
728 /* Symbols */
729
730 /* Table of Ada operators and their GNAT-encoded names. Last entry is pair
731 of NULLs. */
732
733 const struct ada_opname_map ada_opname_table[] = {
734 {"Oadd", "\"+\"", BINOP_ADD},
735 {"Osubtract", "\"-\"", BINOP_SUB},
736 {"Omultiply", "\"*\"", BINOP_MUL},
737 {"Odivide", "\"/\"", BINOP_DIV},
738 {"Omod", "\"mod\"", BINOP_MOD},
739 {"Orem", "\"rem\"", BINOP_REM},
740 {"Oexpon", "\"**\"", BINOP_EXP},
741 {"Olt", "\"<\"", BINOP_LESS},
742 {"Ole", "\"<=\"", BINOP_LEQ},
743 {"Ogt", "\">\"", BINOP_GTR},
744 {"Oge", "\">=\"", BINOP_GEQ},
745 {"Oeq", "\"=\"", BINOP_EQUAL},
746 {"One", "\"/=\"", BINOP_NOTEQUAL},
747 {"Oand", "\"and\"", BINOP_BITWISE_AND},
748 {"Oor", "\"or\"", BINOP_BITWISE_IOR},
749 {"Oxor", "\"xor\"", BINOP_BITWISE_XOR},
750 {"Oconcat", "\"&\"", BINOP_CONCAT},
751 {"Oabs", "\"abs\"", UNOP_ABS},
752 {"Onot", "\"not\"", UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT},
753 {"Oadd", "\"+\"", UNOP_PLUS},
754 {"Osubtract", "\"-\"", UNOP_NEG},
755 {NULL, NULL}
756 };
757
758 /* Return non-zero if STR should be suppressed in info listings. */
759
760 static int
761 is_suppressed_name (const char *str)
762 {
763 if (strncmp (str, "_ada_", 5) == 0)
764 str += 5;
765 if (str[0] == '_' || str[0] == '\000')
766 return 1;
767 else
768 {
769 const char *p;
770 const char *suffix = strstr (str, "___");
771 if (suffix != NULL && suffix[3] != 'X')
772 return 1;
773 if (suffix == NULL)
774 suffix = str + strlen (str);
775 for (p = suffix - 1; p != str; p -= 1)
776 if (isupper (*p))
777 {
778 int i;
779 if (p[0] == 'X' && p[-1] != '_')
780 goto OK;
781 if (*p != 'O')
782 return 1;
783 for (i = 0; ada_opname_table[i].encoded != NULL; i += 1)
784 if (strncmp (ada_opname_table[i].encoded, p,
785 strlen (ada_opname_table[i].encoded)) == 0)
786 goto OK;
787 return 1;
788 OK:;
789 }
790 return 0;
791 }
792 }
793
794 /* The "encoded" form of DECODED, according to GNAT conventions.
795 The result is valid until the next call to ada_encode. */
796
797 char *
798 ada_encode (const char *decoded)
799 {
800 static char *encoding_buffer = NULL;
801 static size_t encoding_buffer_size = 0;
802 const char *p;
803 int k;
804
805 if (decoded == NULL)
806 return NULL;
807
808 GROW_VECT (encoding_buffer, encoding_buffer_size,
809 2 * strlen (decoded) + 10);
810
811 k = 0;
812 for (p = decoded; *p != '\0'; p += 1)
813 {
814 if (!ADA_RETAIN_DOTS && *p == '.')
815 {
816 encoding_buffer[k] = encoding_buffer[k + 1] = '_';
817 k += 2;
818 }
819 else if (*p == '"')
820 {
821 const struct ada_opname_map *mapping;
822
823 for (mapping = ada_opname_table;
824 mapping->encoded != NULL
825 && strncmp (mapping->decoded, p,
826 strlen (mapping->decoded)) != 0; mapping += 1)
827 ;
828 if (mapping->encoded == NULL)
829 error (_("invalid Ada operator name: %s"), p);
830 strcpy (encoding_buffer + k, mapping->encoded);
831 k += strlen (mapping->encoded);
832 break;
833 }
834 else
835 {
836 encoding_buffer[k] = *p;
837 k += 1;
838 }
839 }
840
841 encoding_buffer[k] = '\0';
842 return encoding_buffer;
843 }
844
845 /* Return NAME folded to lower case, or, if surrounded by single
846 quotes, unfolded, but with the quotes stripped away. Result good
847 to next call. */
848
849 char *
850 ada_fold_name (const char *name)
851 {
852 static char *fold_buffer = NULL;
853 static size_t fold_buffer_size = 0;
854
855 int len = strlen (name);
856 GROW_VECT (fold_buffer, fold_buffer_size, len + 1);
857
858 if (name[0] == '\'')
859 {
860 strncpy (fold_buffer, name + 1, len - 2);
861 fold_buffer[len - 2] = '\000';
862 }
863 else
864 {
865 int i;
866 for (i = 0; i <= len; i += 1)
867 fold_buffer[i] = tolower (name[i]);
868 }
869
870 return fold_buffer;
871 }
872
873 /* Return nonzero if C is either a digit or a lowercase alphabet character. */
874
875 static int
876 is_lower_alphanum (const char c)
877 {
878 return (isdigit (c) || (isalpha (c) && islower (c)));
879 }
880
881 /* Remove either of these suffixes:
882 . .{DIGIT}+
883 . ${DIGIT}+
884 . ___{DIGIT}+
885 . __{DIGIT}+.
886 These are suffixes introduced by the compiler for entities such as
887 nested subprogram for instance, in order to avoid name clashes.
888 They do not serve any purpose for the debugger. */
889
890 static void
891 ada_remove_trailing_digits (const char *encoded, int *len)
892 {
893 if (*len > 1 && isdigit (encoded[*len - 1]))
894 {
895 int i = *len - 2;
896 while (i > 0 && isdigit (encoded[i]))
897 i--;
898 if (i >= 0 && encoded[i] == '.')
899 *len = i;
900 else if (i >= 0 && encoded[i] == '$')
901 *len = i;
902 else if (i >= 2 && strncmp (encoded + i - 2, "___", 3) == 0)
903 *len = i - 2;
904 else if (i >= 1 && strncmp (encoded + i - 1, "__", 2) == 0)
905 *len = i - 1;
906 }
907 }
908
909 /* Remove the suffix introduced by the compiler for protected object
910 subprograms. */
911
912 static void
913 ada_remove_po_subprogram_suffix (const char *encoded, int *len)
914 {
915 /* Remove trailing N. */
916
917 /* Protected entry subprograms are broken into two
918 separate subprograms: The first one is unprotected, and has
919 a 'N' suffix; the second is the protected version, and has
920 the 'P' suffix. The second calls the first one after handling
921 the protection. Since the P subprograms are internally generated,
922 we leave these names undecoded, giving the user a clue that this
923 entity is internal. */
924
925 if (*len > 1
926 && encoded[*len - 1] == 'N'
927 && (isdigit (encoded[*len - 2]) || islower (encoded[*len - 2])))
928 *len = *len - 1;
929 }
930
931 /* If ENCODED follows the GNAT entity encoding conventions, then return
932 the decoded form of ENCODED. Otherwise, return "<%s>" where "%s" is
933 replaced by ENCODED.
934
935 The resulting string is valid until the next call of ada_decode.
936 If the string is unchanged by decoding, the original string pointer
937 is returned. */
938
939 const char *
940 ada_decode (const char *encoded)
941 {
942 int i, j;
943 int len0;
944 const char *p;
945 char *decoded;
946 int at_start_name;
947 static char *decoding_buffer = NULL;
948 static size_t decoding_buffer_size = 0;
949
950 /* The name of the Ada main procedure starts with "_ada_".
951 This prefix is not part of the decoded name, so skip this part
952 if we see this prefix. */
953 if (strncmp (encoded, "_ada_", 5) == 0)
954 encoded += 5;
955
956 /* If the name starts with '_', then it is not a properly encoded
957 name, so do not attempt to decode it. Similarly, if the name
958 starts with '<', the name should not be decoded. */
959 if (encoded[0] == '_' || encoded[0] == '<')
960 goto Suppress;
961
962 len0 = strlen (encoded);
963
964 ada_remove_trailing_digits (encoded, &len0);
965 ada_remove_po_subprogram_suffix (encoded, &len0);
966
967 /* Remove the ___X.* suffix if present. Do not forget to verify that
968 the suffix is located before the current "end" of ENCODED. We want
969 to avoid re-matching parts of ENCODED that have previously been
970 marked as discarded (by decrementing LEN0). */
971 p = strstr (encoded, "___");
972 if (p != NULL && p - encoded < len0 - 3)
973 {
974 if (p[3] == 'X')
975 len0 = p - encoded;
976 else
977 goto Suppress;
978 }
979
980 /* Remove any trailing TKB suffix. It tells us that this symbol
981 is for the body of a task, but that information does not actually
982 appear in the decoded name. */
983
984 if (len0 > 3 && strncmp (encoded + len0 - 3, "TKB", 3) == 0)
985 len0 -= 3;
986
987 /* Remove trailing "B" suffixes. */
988 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-04-19: Not sure what this are used for... */
989
990 if (len0 > 1 && strncmp (encoded + len0 - 1, "B", 1) == 0)
991 len0 -= 1;
992
993 /* Make decoded big enough for possible expansion by operator name. */
994
995 GROW_VECT (decoding_buffer, decoding_buffer_size, 2 * len0 + 1);
996 decoded = decoding_buffer;
997
998 /* Remove trailing __{digit}+ or trailing ${digit}+. */
999
1000 if (len0 > 1 && isdigit (encoded[len0 - 1]))
1001 {
1002 i = len0 - 2;
1003 while ((i >= 0 && isdigit (encoded[i]))
1004 || (i >= 1 && encoded[i] == '_' && isdigit (encoded[i - 1])))
1005 i -= 1;
1006 if (i > 1 && encoded[i] == '_' && encoded[i - 1] == '_')
1007 len0 = i - 1;
1008 else if (encoded[i] == '$')
1009 len0 = i;
1010 }
1011
1012 /* The first few characters that are not alphabetic are not part
1013 of any encoding we use, so we can copy them over verbatim. */
1014
1015 for (i = 0, j = 0; i < len0 && !isalpha (encoded[i]); i += 1, j += 1)
1016 decoded[j] = encoded[i];
1017
1018 at_start_name = 1;
1019 while (i < len0)
1020 {
1021 /* Is this a symbol function? */
1022 if (at_start_name && encoded[i] == 'O')
1023 {
1024 int k;
1025 for (k = 0; ada_opname_table[k].encoded != NULL; k += 1)
1026 {
1027 int op_len = strlen (ada_opname_table[k].encoded);
1028 if ((strncmp (ada_opname_table[k].encoded + 1, encoded + i + 1,
1029 op_len - 1) == 0)
1030 && !isalnum (encoded[i + op_len]))
1031 {
1032 strcpy (decoded + j, ada_opname_table[k].decoded);
1033 at_start_name = 0;
1034 i += op_len;
1035 j += strlen (ada_opname_table[k].decoded);
1036 break;
1037 }
1038 }
1039 if (ada_opname_table[k].encoded != NULL)
1040 continue;
1041 }
1042 at_start_name = 0;
1043
1044 /* Replace "TK__" with "__", which will eventually be translated
1045 into "." (just below). */
1046
1047 if (i < len0 - 4 && strncmp (encoded + i, "TK__", 4) == 0)
1048 i += 2;
1049
1050 /* Replace "__B_{DIGITS}+__" sequences by "__", which will eventually
1051 be translated into "." (just below). These are internal names
1052 generated for anonymous blocks inside which our symbol is nested. */
1053
1054 if (len0 - i > 5 && encoded [i] == '_' && encoded [i+1] == '_'
1055 && encoded [i+2] == 'B' && encoded [i+3] == '_'
1056 && isdigit (encoded [i+4]))
1057 {
1058 int k = i + 5;
1059
1060 while (k < len0 && isdigit (encoded[k]))
1061 k++; /* Skip any extra digit. */
1062
1063 /* Double-check that the "__B_{DIGITS}+" sequence we found
1064 is indeed followed by "__". */
1065 if (len0 - k > 2 && encoded [k] == '_' && encoded [k+1] == '_')
1066 i = k;
1067 }
1068
1069 /* Remove _E{DIGITS}+[sb] */
1070
1071 /* Just as for protected object subprograms, there are 2 categories
1072 of subprograms created by the compiler for each entry. The first
1073 one implements the actual entry code, and has a suffix following
1074 the convention above; the second one implements the barrier and
1075 uses the same convention as above, except that the 'E' is replaced
1076 by a 'B'.
1077
1078 Just as above, we do not decode the name of barrier functions
1079 to give the user a clue that the code he is debugging has been
1080 internally generated. */
1081
1082 if (len0 - i > 3 && encoded [i] == '_' && encoded[i+1] == 'E'
1083 && isdigit (encoded[i+2]))
1084 {
1085 int k = i + 3;
1086
1087 while (k < len0 && isdigit (encoded[k]))
1088 k++;
1089
1090 if (k < len0
1091 && (encoded[k] == 'b' || encoded[k] == 's'))
1092 {
1093 k++;
1094 /* Just as an extra precaution, make sure that if this
1095 suffix is followed by anything else, it is a '_'.
1096 Otherwise, we matched this sequence by accident. */
1097 if (k == len0
1098 || (k < len0 && encoded[k] == '_'))
1099 i = k;
1100 }
1101 }
1102
1103 /* Remove trailing "N" in [a-z0-9]+N__. The N is added by
1104 the GNAT front-end in protected object subprograms. */
1105
1106 if (i < len0 + 3
1107 && encoded[i] == 'N' && encoded[i+1] == '_' && encoded[i+2] == '_')
1108 {
1109 /* Backtrack a bit up until we reach either the begining of
1110 the encoded name, or "__". Make sure that we only find
1111 digits or lowercase characters. */
1112 const char *ptr = encoded + i - 1;
1113
1114 while (ptr >= encoded && is_lower_alphanum (ptr[0]))
1115 ptr--;
1116 if (ptr < encoded
1117 || (ptr > encoded && ptr[0] == '_' && ptr[-1] == '_'))
1118 i++;
1119 }
1120
1121 if (encoded[i] == 'X' && i != 0 && isalnum (encoded[i - 1]))
1122 {
1123 /* This is a X[bn]* sequence not separated from the previous
1124 part of the name with a non-alpha-numeric character (in other
1125 words, immediately following an alpha-numeric character), then
1126 verify that it is placed at the end of the encoded name. If
1127 not, then the encoding is not valid and we should abort the
1128 decoding. Otherwise, just skip it, it is used in body-nested
1129 package names. */
1130 do
1131 i += 1;
1132 while (i < len0 && (encoded[i] == 'b' || encoded[i] == 'n'));
1133 if (i < len0)
1134 goto Suppress;
1135 }
1136 else if (!ADA_RETAIN_DOTS
1137 && i < len0 - 2 && encoded[i] == '_' && encoded[i + 1] == '_')
1138 {
1139 /* Replace '__' by '.'. */
1140 decoded[j] = '.';
1141 at_start_name = 1;
1142 i += 2;
1143 j += 1;
1144 }
1145 else
1146 {
1147 /* It's a character part of the decoded name, so just copy it
1148 over. */
1149 decoded[j] = encoded[i];
1150 i += 1;
1151 j += 1;
1152 }
1153 }
1154 decoded[j] = '\000';
1155
1156 /* Decoded names should never contain any uppercase character.
1157 Double-check this, and abort the decoding if we find one. */
1158
1159 for (i = 0; decoded[i] != '\0'; i += 1)
1160 if (isupper (decoded[i]) || decoded[i] == ' ')
1161 goto Suppress;
1162
1163 if (strcmp (decoded, encoded) == 0)
1164 return encoded;
1165 else
1166 return decoded;
1167
1168 Suppress:
1169 GROW_VECT (decoding_buffer, decoding_buffer_size, strlen (encoded) + 3);
1170 decoded = decoding_buffer;
1171 if (encoded[0] == '<')
1172 strcpy (decoded, encoded);
1173 else
1174 sprintf (decoded, "<%s>", encoded);
1175 return decoded;
1176
1177 }
1178
1179 /* Table for keeping permanent unique copies of decoded names. Once
1180 allocated, names in this table are never released. While this is a
1181 storage leak, it should not be significant unless there are massive
1182 changes in the set of decoded names in successive versions of a
1183 symbol table loaded during a single session. */
1184 static struct htab *decoded_names_store;
1185
1186 /* Returns the decoded name of GSYMBOL, as for ada_decode, caching it
1187 in the language-specific part of GSYMBOL, if it has not been
1188 previously computed. Tries to save the decoded name in the same
1189 obstack as GSYMBOL, if possible, and otherwise on the heap (so that,
1190 in any case, the decoded symbol has a lifetime at least that of
1191 GSYMBOL).
1192 The GSYMBOL parameter is "mutable" in the C++ sense: logically
1193 const, but nevertheless modified to a semantically equivalent form
1194 when a decoded name is cached in it.
1195 */
1196
1197 char *
1198 ada_decode_symbol (const struct general_symbol_info *gsymbol)
1199 {
1200 char **resultp =
1201 (char **) &gsymbol->language_specific.cplus_specific.demangled_name;
1202 if (*resultp == NULL)
1203 {
1204 const char *decoded = ada_decode (gsymbol->name);
1205 if (gsymbol->bfd_section != NULL)
1206 {
1207 bfd *obfd = gsymbol->bfd_section->owner;
1208 if (obfd != NULL)
1209 {
1210 struct objfile *objf;
1211 ALL_OBJFILES (objf)
1212 {
1213 if (obfd == objf->obfd)
1214 {
1215 *resultp = obsavestring (decoded, strlen (decoded),
1216 &objf->objfile_obstack);
1217 break;
1218 }
1219 }
1220 }
1221 }
1222 /* Sometimes, we can't find a corresponding objfile, in which
1223 case, we put the result on the heap. Since we only decode
1224 when needed, we hope this usually does not cause a
1225 significant memory leak (FIXME). */
1226 if (*resultp == NULL)
1227 {
1228 char **slot = (char **) htab_find_slot (decoded_names_store,
1229 decoded, INSERT);
1230 if (*slot == NULL)
1231 *slot = xstrdup (decoded);
1232 *resultp = *slot;
1233 }
1234 }
1235
1236 return *resultp;
1237 }
1238
1239 char *
1240 ada_la_decode (const char *encoded, int options)
1241 {
1242 return xstrdup (ada_decode (encoded));
1243 }
1244
1245 /* Returns non-zero iff SYM_NAME matches NAME, ignoring any trailing
1246 suffixes that encode debugging information or leading _ada_ on
1247 SYM_NAME (see is_name_suffix commentary for the debugging
1248 information that is ignored). If WILD, then NAME need only match a
1249 suffix of SYM_NAME minus the same suffixes. Also returns 0 if
1250 either argument is NULL. */
1251
1252 int
1253 ada_match_name (const char *sym_name, const char *name, int wild)
1254 {
1255 if (sym_name == NULL || name == NULL)
1256 return 0;
1257 else if (wild)
1258 return wild_match (name, strlen (name), sym_name);
1259 else
1260 {
1261 int len_name = strlen (name);
1262 return (strncmp (sym_name, name, len_name) == 0
1263 && is_name_suffix (sym_name + len_name))
1264 || (strncmp (sym_name, "_ada_", 5) == 0
1265 && strncmp (sym_name + 5, name, len_name) == 0
1266 && is_name_suffix (sym_name + len_name + 5));
1267 }
1268 }
1269
1270 /* True (non-zero) iff, in Ada mode, the symbol SYM should be
1271 suppressed in info listings. */
1272
1273 int
1274 ada_suppress_symbol_printing (struct symbol *sym)
1275 {
1276 if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym) == STRUCT_DOMAIN)
1277 return 1;
1278 else
1279 return is_suppressed_name (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym));
1280 }
1281 \f
1282
1283 /* Arrays */
1284
1285 /* Names of MAX_ADA_DIMENS bounds in P_BOUNDS fields of array descriptors. */
1286
1287 static char *bound_name[] = {
1288 "LB0", "UB0", "LB1", "UB1", "LB2", "UB2", "LB3", "UB3",
1289 "LB4", "UB4", "LB5", "UB5", "LB6", "UB6", "LB7", "UB7"
1290 };
1291
1292 /* Maximum number of array dimensions we are prepared to handle. */
1293
1294 #define MAX_ADA_DIMENS (sizeof(bound_name) / (2*sizeof(char *)))
1295
1296 /* Like modify_field, but allows bitpos > wordlength. */
1297
1298 static void
1299 modify_general_field (char *addr, LONGEST fieldval, int bitpos, int bitsize)
1300 {
1301 modify_field (addr + bitpos / 8, fieldval, bitpos % 8, bitsize);
1302 }
1303
1304
1305 /* The desc_* routines return primitive portions of array descriptors
1306 (fat pointers). */
1307
1308 /* The descriptor or array type, if any, indicated by TYPE; removes
1309 level of indirection, if needed. */
1310
1311 static struct type *
1312 desc_base_type (struct type *type)
1313 {
1314 if (type == NULL)
1315 return NULL;
1316 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1317 if (type != NULL
1318 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1319 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF))
1320 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
1321 else
1322 return type;
1323 }
1324
1325 /* True iff TYPE indicates a "thin" array pointer type. */
1326
1327 static int
1328 is_thin_pntr (struct type *type)
1329 {
1330 return
1331 is_suffix (ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type)), "___XUT")
1332 || is_suffix (ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type)), "___XUT___XVE");
1333 }
1334
1335 /* The descriptor type for thin pointer type TYPE. */
1336
1337 static struct type *
1338 thin_descriptor_type (struct type *type)
1339 {
1340 struct type *base_type = desc_base_type (type);
1341 if (base_type == NULL)
1342 return NULL;
1343 if (is_suffix (ada_type_name (base_type), "___XVE"))
1344 return base_type;
1345 else
1346 {
1347 struct type *alt_type = ada_find_parallel_type (base_type, "___XVE");
1348 if (alt_type == NULL)
1349 return base_type;
1350 else
1351 return alt_type;
1352 }
1353 }
1354
1355 /* A pointer to the array data for thin-pointer value VAL. */
1356
1357 static struct value *
1358 thin_data_pntr (struct value *val)
1359 {
1360 struct type *type = value_type (val);
1361 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1362 return value_cast (desc_data_type (thin_descriptor_type (type)),
1363 value_copy (val));
1364 else
1365 return value_from_longest (desc_data_type (thin_descriptor_type (type)),
1366 VALUE_ADDRESS (val) + value_offset (val));
1367 }
1368
1369 /* True iff TYPE indicates a "thick" array pointer type. */
1370
1371 static int
1372 is_thick_pntr (struct type *type)
1373 {
1374 type = desc_base_type (type);
1375 return (type != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1376 && lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1) != NULL);
1377 }
1378
1379 /* If TYPE is the type of an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer) or a
1380 pointer to one, the type of its bounds data; otherwise, NULL. */
1381
1382 static struct type *
1383 desc_bounds_type (struct type *type)
1384 {
1385 struct type *r;
1386
1387 type = desc_base_type (type);
1388
1389 if (type == NULL)
1390 return NULL;
1391 else if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1392 {
1393 type = thin_descriptor_type (type);
1394 if (type == NULL)
1395 return NULL;
1396 r = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "BOUNDS", 1);
1397 if (r != NULL)
1398 return ada_check_typedef (r);
1399 }
1400 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
1401 {
1402 r = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1);
1403 if (r != NULL)
1404 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ada_check_typedef (r)));
1405 }
1406 return NULL;
1407 }
1408
1409 /* If ARR is an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer), or pointer to
1410 one, a pointer to its bounds data. Otherwise NULL. */
1411
1412 static struct value *
1413 desc_bounds (struct value *arr)
1414 {
1415 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
1416 if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1417 {
1418 struct type *bounds_type =
1419 desc_bounds_type (thin_descriptor_type (type));
1420 LONGEST addr;
1421
1422 if (bounds_type == NULL)
1423 error (_("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1424
1425 /* NOTE: The following calculation is not really kosher, but
1426 since desc_type is an XVE-encoded type (and shouldn't be),
1427 the correct calculation is a real pain. FIXME (and fix GCC). */
1428 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1429 addr = value_as_long (arr);
1430 else
1431 addr = VALUE_ADDRESS (arr) + value_offset (arr);
1432
1433 return
1434 value_from_longest (lookup_pointer_type (bounds_type),
1435 addr - TYPE_LENGTH (bounds_type));
1436 }
1437
1438 else if (is_thick_pntr (type))
1439 return value_struct_elt (&arr, NULL, "P_BOUNDS", NULL,
1440 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1441 else
1442 return NULL;
1443 }
1444
1445 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1446 position of the field containing the address of the bounds data. */
1447
1448 static int
1449 fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (struct type *type)
1450 {
1451 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 1);
1452 }
1453
1454 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1455 size of the field containing the address of the bounds data. */
1456
1457 static int
1458 fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (struct type *type)
1459 {
1460 type = desc_base_type (type);
1461
1462 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 1) > 0)
1463 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 1);
1464 else
1465 return 8 * TYPE_LENGTH (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 1)));
1466 }
1467
1468 /* If TYPE is the type of an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer) or a
1469 pointer to one, the type of its array data (a
1470 pointer-to-array-with-no-bounds type); otherwise, NULL. Use
1471 ada_type_of_array to get an array type with bounds data. */
1472
1473 static struct type *
1474 desc_data_type (struct type *type)
1475 {
1476 type = desc_base_type (type);
1477
1478 /* NOTE: The following is bogus; see comment in desc_bounds. */
1479 if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1480 return lookup_pointer_type
1481 (desc_base_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (thin_descriptor_type (type), 1)));
1482 else if (is_thick_pntr (type))
1483 return lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_ARRAY", 1);
1484 else
1485 return NULL;
1486 }
1487
1488 /* If ARR is an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer), a pointer to
1489 its array data. */
1490
1491 static struct value *
1492 desc_data (struct value *arr)
1493 {
1494 struct type *type = value_type (arr);
1495 if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1496 return thin_data_pntr (arr);
1497 else if (is_thick_pntr (type))
1498 return value_struct_elt (&arr, NULL, "P_ARRAY", NULL,
1499 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1500 else
1501 return NULL;
1502 }
1503
1504
1505 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1506 position of the field containing the address of the data. */
1507
1508 static int
1509 fat_pntr_data_bitpos (struct type *type)
1510 {
1511 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 0);
1512 }
1513
1514 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1515 size of the field containing the address of the data. */
1516
1517 static int
1518 fat_pntr_data_bitsize (struct type *type)
1519 {
1520 type = desc_base_type (type);
1521
1522 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 0) > 0)
1523 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 0);
1524 else
1525 return TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0));
1526 }
1527
1528 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure (or pointer to one), return
1529 the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper
1530 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */
1531
1532 static struct value *
1533 desc_one_bound (struct value *bounds, int i, int which)
1534 {
1535 return value_struct_elt (&bounds, NULL, bound_name[2 * i + which - 2], NULL,
1536 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor bounds"));
1537 }
1538
1539 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure type, return the bit position
1540 of the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper
1541 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */
1542
1543 static int
1544 desc_bound_bitpos (struct type *type, int i, int which)
1545 {
1546 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 2 * i + which - 2);
1547 }
1548
1549 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure type, return the bit field size
1550 of the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper
1551 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */
1552
1553 static int
1554 desc_bound_bitsize (struct type *type, int i, int which)
1555 {
1556 type = desc_base_type (type);
1557
1558 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 2 * i + which - 2) > 0)
1559 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 2 * i + which - 2);
1560 else
1561 return 8 * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 2 * i + which - 2));
1562 }
1563
1564 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-bounds structure, the type of its
1565 Ith bound (numbering from 1). Otherwise, NULL. */
1566
1567 static struct type *
1568 desc_index_type (struct type *type, int i)
1569 {
1570 type = desc_base_type (type);
1571
1572 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
1573 return lookup_struct_elt_type (type, bound_name[2 * i - 2], 1);
1574 else
1575 return NULL;
1576 }
1577
1578 /* The number of index positions in the array-bounds type TYPE.
1579 Return 0 if TYPE is NULL. */
1580
1581 static int
1582 desc_arity (struct type *type)
1583 {
1584 type = desc_base_type (type);
1585
1586 if (type != NULL)
1587 return TYPE_NFIELDS (type) / 2;
1588 return 0;
1589 }
1590
1591 /* Non-zero iff TYPE is a simple array type (not a pointer to one) or
1592 an array descriptor type (representing an unconstrained array
1593 type). */
1594
1595 static int
1596 ada_is_direct_array_type (struct type *type)
1597 {
1598 if (type == NULL)
1599 return 0;
1600 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1601 return (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1602 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type));
1603 }
1604
1605 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents any kind of array in Ada, or a pointer
1606 * to one. */
1607
1608 int
1609 ada_is_array_type (struct type *type)
1610 {
1611 while (type != NULL
1612 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1613 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF))
1614 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
1615 return ada_is_direct_array_type (type);
1616 }
1617
1618 /* Non-zero iff TYPE is a simple array type or pointer to one. */
1619
1620 int
1621 ada_is_simple_array_type (struct type *type)
1622 {
1623 if (type == NULL)
1624 return 0;
1625 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1626 return (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1627 || (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1628 && TYPE_CODE (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY));
1629 }
1630
1631 /* Non-zero iff TYPE belongs to a GNAT array descriptor. */
1632
1633 int
1634 ada_is_array_descriptor_type (struct type *type)
1635 {
1636 struct type *data_type = desc_data_type (type);
1637
1638 if (type == NULL)
1639 return 0;
1640 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1641 return
1642 data_type != NULL
1643 && ((TYPE_CODE (data_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1644 && TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (data_type) != NULL
1645 && TYPE_CODE (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (data_type)) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
1646 || TYPE_CODE (data_type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
1647 && desc_arity (desc_bounds_type (type)) > 0;
1648 }
1649
1650 /* Non-zero iff type is a partially mal-formed GNAT array
1651 descriptor. FIXME: This is to compensate for some problems with
1652 debugging output from GNAT. Re-examine periodically to see if it
1653 is still needed. */
1654
1655 int
1656 ada_is_bogus_array_descriptor (struct type *type)
1657 {
1658 return
1659 type != NULL
1660 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1661 && (lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1) != NULL
1662 || lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_ARRAY", 1) != NULL)
1663 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type);
1664 }
1665
1666
1667 /* If ARR has a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array descriptor,
1668 (fat pointer) returns the type of the array data described---specifically,
1669 a pointer-to-array type. If BOUNDS is non-zero, the bounds data are filled
1670 in from the descriptor; otherwise, they are left unspecified. If
1671 the ARR denotes a null array descriptor and BOUNDS is non-zero,
1672 returns NULL. The result is simply the type of ARR if ARR is not
1673 a descriptor. */
1674 struct type *
1675 ada_type_of_array (struct value *arr, int bounds)
1676 {
1677 if (ada_is_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1678 return decode_packed_array_type (value_type (arr));
1679
1680 if (!ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr)))
1681 return value_type (arr);
1682
1683 if (!bounds)
1684 return
1685 ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (desc_data_type (value_type (arr))));
1686 else
1687 {
1688 struct type *elt_type;
1689 int arity;
1690 struct value *descriptor;
1691 struct objfile *objf = TYPE_OBJFILE (value_type (arr));
1692
1693 elt_type = ada_array_element_type (value_type (arr), -1);
1694 arity = ada_array_arity (value_type (arr));
1695
1696 if (elt_type == NULL || arity == 0)
1697 return ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
1698
1699 descriptor = desc_bounds (arr);
1700 if (value_as_long (descriptor) == 0)
1701 return NULL;
1702 while (arity > 0)
1703 {
1704 struct type *range_type = alloc_type (objf);
1705 struct type *array_type = alloc_type (objf);
1706 struct value *low = desc_one_bound (descriptor, arity, 0);
1707 struct value *high = desc_one_bound (descriptor, arity, 1);
1708 arity -= 1;
1709
1710 create_range_type (range_type, value_type (low),
1711 longest_to_int (value_as_long (low)),
1712 longest_to_int (value_as_long (high)));
1713 elt_type = create_array_type (array_type, elt_type, range_type);
1714 }
1715
1716 return lookup_pointer_type (elt_type);
1717 }
1718 }
1719
1720 /* If ARR does not represent an array, returns ARR unchanged.
1721 Otherwise, returns either a standard GDB array with bounds set
1722 appropriately or, if ARR is a non-null fat pointer, a pointer to a standard
1723 GDB array. Returns NULL if ARR is a null fat pointer. */
1724
1725 struct value *
1726 ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (struct value *arr)
1727 {
1728 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr)))
1729 {
1730 struct type *arrType = ada_type_of_array (arr, 1);
1731 if (arrType == NULL)
1732 return NULL;
1733 return value_cast (arrType, value_copy (desc_data (arr)));
1734 }
1735 else if (ada_is_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1736 return decode_packed_array (arr);
1737 else
1738 return arr;
1739 }
1740
1741 /* If ARR does not represent an array, returns ARR unchanged.
1742 Otherwise, returns a standard GDB array describing ARR (which may
1743 be ARR itself if it already is in the proper form). */
1744
1745 static struct value *
1746 ada_coerce_to_simple_array (struct value *arr)
1747 {
1748 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr)))
1749 {
1750 struct value *arrVal = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (arr);
1751 if (arrVal == NULL)
1752 error (_("Bounds unavailable for null array pointer."));
1753 check_size (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (arrVal)));
1754 return value_ind (arrVal);
1755 }
1756 else if (ada_is_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1757 return decode_packed_array (arr);
1758 else
1759 return arr;
1760 }
1761
1762 /* If TYPE represents a GNAT array type, return it translated to an
1763 ordinary GDB array type (possibly with BITSIZE fields indicating
1764 packing). For other types, is the identity. */
1765
1766 struct type *
1767 ada_coerce_to_simple_array_type (struct type *type)
1768 {
1769 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
1770 struct value *dummy = value_from_longest (builtin_type_long, 0);
1771 struct type *result;
1772 deprecated_set_value_type (dummy, type);
1773 result = ada_type_of_array (dummy, 0);
1774 value_free_to_mark (mark);
1775 return result;
1776 }
1777
1778 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents a standard GNAT packed-array type. */
1779
1780 int
1781 ada_is_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
1782 {
1783 if (type == NULL)
1784 return 0;
1785 type = desc_base_type (type);
1786 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1787 return
1788 ada_type_name (type) != NULL
1789 && strstr (ada_type_name (type), "___XP") != NULL;
1790 }
1791
1792 /* Given that TYPE is a standard GDB array type with all bounds filled
1793 in, and that the element size of its ultimate scalar constituents
1794 (that is, either its elements, or, if it is an array of arrays, its
1795 elements' elements, etc.) is *ELT_BITS, return an identical type,
1796 but with the bit sizes of its elements (and those of any
1797 constituent arrays) recorded in the BITSIZE components of its
1798 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE values, and with *ELT_BITS set to its total size
1799 in bits. */
1800
1801 static struct type *
1802 packed_array_type (struct type *type, long *elt_bits)
1803 {
1804 struct type *new_elt_type;
1805 struct type *new_type;
1806 LONGEST low_bound, high_bound;
1807
1808 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1809 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
1810 return type;
1811
1812 new_type = alloc_type (TYPE_OBJFILE (type));
1813 new_elt_type = packed_array_type (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)),
1814 elt_bits);
1815 create_array_type (new_type, new_elt_type, TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0));
1816 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (new_type, 0) = *elt_bits;
1817 TYPE_NAME (new_type) = ada_type_name (type);
1818
1819 if (get_discrete_bounds (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0),
1820 &low_bound, &high_bound) < 0)
1821 low_bound = high_bound = 0;
1822 if (high_bound < low_bound)
1823 *elt_bits = TYPE_LENGTH (new_type) = 0;
1824 else
1825 {
1826 *elt_bits *= (high_bound - low_bound + 1);
1827 TYPE_LENGTH (new_type) =
1828 (*elt_bits + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
1829 }
1830
1831 TYPE_FLAGS (new_type) |= TYPE_FLAG_FIXED_INSTANCE;
1832 return new_type;
1833 }
1834
1835 /* The array type encoded by TYPE, where ada_is_packed_array_type (TYPE). */
1836
1837 static struct type *
1838 decode_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
1839 {
1840 struct symbol *sym;
1841 struct block **blocks;
1842 char *raw_name = ada_type_name (ada_check_typedef (type));
1843 char *name;
1844 char *tail;
1845 struct type *shadow_type;
1846 long bits;
1847 int i, n;
1848
1849 if (!raw_name)
1850 raw_name = ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type));
1851
1852 if (!raw_name)
1853 return NULL;
1854
1855 name = (char *) alloca (strlen (raw_name) + 1);
1856 tail = strstr (raw_name, "___XP");
1857 type = desc_base_type (type);
1858
1859 memcpy (name, raw_name, tail - raw_name);
1860 name[tail - raw_name] = '\000';
1861
1862 sym = standard_lookup (name, get_selected_block (0), VAR_DOMAIN);
1863 if (sym == NULL || SYMBOL_TYPE (sym) == NULL)
1864 {
1865 lim_warning (_("could not find bounds information on packed array"));
1866 return NULL;
1867 }
1868 shadow_type = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym);
1869
1870 if (TYPE_CODE (shadow_type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
1871 {
1872 lim_warning (_("could not understand bounds information on packed array"));
1873 return NULL;
1874 }
1875
1876 if (sscanf (tail + sizeof ("___XP") - 1, "%ld", &bits) != 1)
1877 {
1878 lim_warning
1879 (_("could not understand bit size information on packed array"));
1880 return NULL;
1881 }
1882
1883 return packed_array_type (shadow_type, &bits);
1884 }
1885
1886 /* Given that ARR is a struct value *indicating a GNAT packed array,
1887 returns a simple array that denotes that array. Its type is a
1888 standard GDB array type except that the BITSIZEs of the array
1889 target types are set to the number of bits in each element, and the
1890 type length is set appropriately. */
1891
1892 static struct value *
1893 decode_packed_array (struct value *arr)
1894 {
1895 struct type *type;
1896
1897 arr = ada_coerce_ref (arr);
1898 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arr)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1899 arr = ada_value_ind (arr);
1900
1901 type = decode_packed_array_type (value_type (arr));
1902 if (type == NULL)
1903 {
1904 error (_("can't unpack array"));
1905 return NULL;
1906 }
1907
1908 if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (current_gdbarch)
1909 && ada_is_modular_type (value_type (arr)))
1910 {
1911 /* This is a (right-justified) modular type representing a packed
1912 array with no wrapper. In order to interpret the value through
1913 the (left-justified) packed array type we just built, we must
1914 first left-justify it. */
1915 int bit_size, bit_pos;
1916 ULONGEST mod;
1917
1918 mod = ada_modulus (value_type (arr)) - 1;
1919 bit_size = 0;
1920 while (mod > 0)
1921 {
1922 bit_size += 1;
1923 mod >>= 1;
1924 }
1925 bit_pos = HOST_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arr)) - bit_size;
1926 arr = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arr, NULL,
1927 bit_pos / HOST_CHAR_BIT,
1928 bit_pos % HOST_CHAR_BIT,
1929 bit_size,
1930 type);
1931 }
1932
1933 return coerce_unspec_val_to_type (arr, type);
1934 }
1935
1936
1937 /* The value of the element of packed array ARR at the ARITY indices
1938 given in IND. ARR must be a simple array. */
1939
1940 static struct value *
1941 value_subscript_packed (struct value *arr, int arity, struct value **ind)
1942 {
1943 int i;
1944 int bits, elt_off, bit_off;
1945 long elt_total_bit_offset;
1946 struct type *elt_type;
1947 struct value *v;
1948
1949 bits = 0;
1950 elt_total_bit_offset = 0;
1951 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
1952 for (i = 0; i < arity; i += 1)
1953 {
1954 if (TYPE_CODE (elt_type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1955 || TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) == 0)
1956 error
1957 (_("attempt to do packed indexing of something other than a packed array"));
1958 else
1959 {
1960 struct type *range_type = TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (elt_type);
1961 LONGEST lowerbound, upperbound;
1962 LONGEST idx;
1963
1964 if (get_discrete_bounds (range_type, &lowerbound, &upperbound) < 0)
1965 {
1966 lim_warning (_("don't know bounds of array"));
1967 lowerbound = upperbound = 0;
1968 }
1969
1970 idx = value_as_long (value_pos_atr (ind[i]));
1971 if (idx < lowerbound || idx > upperbound)
1972 lim_warning (_("packed array index %ld out of bounds"), (long) idx);
1973 bits = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0);
1974 elt_total_bit_offset += (idx - lowerbound) * bits;
1975 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type));
1976 }
1977 }
1978 elt_off = elt_total_bit_offset / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
1979 bit_off = elt_total_bit_offset % HOST_CHAR_BIT;
1980
1981 v = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arr, NULL, elt_off, bit_off,
1982 bits, elt_type);
1983 return v;
1984 }
1985
1986 /* Non-zero iff TYPE includes negative integer values. */
1987
1988 static int
1989 has_negatives (struct type *type)
1990 {
1991 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
1992 {
1993 default:
1994 return 0;
1995 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
1996 return !TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
1997 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
1998 return TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type) < 0;
1999 }
2000 }
2001
2002
2003 /* Create a new value of type TYPE from the contents of OBJ starting
2004 at byte OFFSET, and bit offset BIT_OFFSET within that byte,
2005 proceeding for BIT_SIZE bits. If OBJ is an lval in memory, then
2006 assigning through the result will set the field fetched from.
2007 VALADDR is ignored unless OBJ is NULL, in which case,
2008 VALADDR+OFFSET must address the start of storage containing the
2009 packed value. The value returned in this case is never an lval.
2010 Assumes 0 <= BIT_OFFSET < HOST_CHAR_BIT. */
2011
2012 struct value *
2013 ada_value_primitive_packed_val (struct value *obj, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
2014 long offset, int bit_offset, int bit_size,
2015 struct type *type)
2016 {
2017 struct value *v;
2018 int src, /* Index into the source area */
2019 targ, /* Index into the target area */
2020 srcBitsLeft, /* Number of source bits left to move */
2021 nsrc, ntarg, /* Number of source and target bytes */
2022 unusedLS, /* Number of bits in next significant
2023 byte of source that are unused */
2024 accumSize; /* Number of meaningful bits in accum */
2025 unsigned char *bytes; /* First byte containing data to unpack */
2026 unsigned char *unpacked;
2027 unsigned long accum; /* Staging area for bits being transferred */
2028 unsigned char sign;
2029 int len = (bit_size + bit_offset + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / 8;
2030 /* Transmit bytes from least to most significant; delta is the direction
2031 the indices move. */
2032 int delta = gdbarch_bits_big_endian (current_gdbarch) ? -1 : 1;
2033
2034 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
2035
2036 if (obj == NULL)
2037 {
2038 v = allocate_value (type);
2039 bytes = (unsigned char *) (valaddr + offset);
2040 }
2041 else if (VALUE_LVAL (obj) == lval_memory && value_lazy (obj))
2042 {
2043 v = value_at (type,
2044 VALUE_ADDRESS (obj) + value_offset (obj) + offset);
2045 bytes = (unsigned char *) alloca (len);
2046 read_memory (VALUE_ADDRESS (v), bytes, len);
2047 }
2048 else
2049 {
2050 v = allocate_value (type);
2051 bytes = (unsigned char *) value_contents (obj) + offset;
2052 }
2053
2054 if (obj != NULL)
2055 {
2056 VALUE_LVAL (v) = VALUE_LVAL (obj);
2057 if (VALUE_LVAL (obj) == lval_internalvar)
2058 VALUE_LVAL (v) = lval_internalvar_component;
2059 VALUE_ADDRESS (v) = VALUE_ADDRESS (obj) + value_offset (obj) + offset;
2060 set_value_bitpos (v, bit_offset + value_bitpos (obj));
2061 set_value_bitsize (v, bit_size);
2062 if (value_bitpos (v) >= HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2063 {
2064 VALUE_ADDRESS (v) += 1;
2065 set_value_bitpos (v, value_bitpos (v) - HOST_CHAR_BIT);
2066 }
2067 }
2068 else
2069 set_value_bitsize (v, bit_size);
2070 unpacked = (unsigned char *) value_contents (v);
2071
2072 srcBitsLeft = bit_size;
2073 nsrc = len;
2074 ntarg = TYPE_LENGTH (type);
2075 sign = 0;
2076 if (bit_size == 0)
2077 {
2078 memset (unpacked, 0, TYPE_LENGTH (type));
2079 return v;
2080 }
2081 else if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (current_gdbarch))
2082 {
2083 src = len - 1;
2084 if (has_negatives (type)
2085 && ((bytes[0] << bit_offset) & (1 << (HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1))))
2086 sign = ~0;
2087
2088 unusedLS =
2089 (HOST_CHAR_BIT - (bit_size + bit_offset) % HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2090 % HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2091
2092 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
2093 {
2094 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
2095 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
2096 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
2097 /* Non-scalar values must be aligned at a byte boundary... */
2098 accumSize =
2099 (HOST_CHAR_BIT - bit_size % HOST_CHAR_BIT) % HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2100 /* ... And are placed at the beginning (most-significant) bytes
2101 of the target. */
2102 targ = (bit_size + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1;
2103 break;
2104 default:
2105 accumSize = 0;
2106 targ = TYPE_LENGTH (type) - 1;
2107 break;
2108 }
2109 }
2110 else
2111 {
2112 int sign_bit_offset = (bit_size + bit_offset - 1) % 8;
2113
2114 src = targ = 0;
2115 unusedLS = bit_offset;
2116 accumSize = 0;
2117
2118 if (has_negatives (type) && (bytes[len - 1] & (1 << sign_bit_offset)))
2119 sign = ~0;
2120 }
2121
2122 accum = 0;
2123 while (nsrc > 0)
2124 {
2125 /* Mask for removing bits of the next source byte that are not
2126 part of the value. */
2127 unsigned int unusedMSMask =
2128 (1 << (srcBitsLeft >= HOST_CHAR_BIT ? HOST_CHAR_BIT : srcBitsLeft)) -
2129 1;
2130 /* Sign-extend bits for this byte. */
2131 unsigned int signMask = sign & ~unusedMSMask;
2132 accum |=
2133 (((bytes[src] >> unusedLS) & unusedMSMask) | signMask) << accumSize;
2134 accumSize += HOST_CHAR_BIT - unusedLS;
2135 if (accumSize >= HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2136 {
2137 unpacked[targ] = accum & ~(~0L << HOST_CHAR_BIT);
2138 accumSize -= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2139 accum >>= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2140 ntarg -= 1;
2141 targ += delta;
2142 }
2143 srcBitsLeft -= HOST_CHAR_BIT - unusedLS;
2144 unusedLS = 0;
2145 nsrc -= 1;
2146 src += delta;
2147 }
2148 while (ntarg > 0)
2149 {
2150 accum |= sign << accumSize;
2151 unpacked[targ] = accum & ~(~0L << HOST_CHAR_BIT);
2152 accumSize -= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2153 accum >>= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2154 ntarg -= 1;
2155 targ += delta;
2156 }
2157
2158 return v;
2159 }
2160
2161 /* Move N bits from SOURCE, starting at bit offset SRC_OFFSET to
2162 TARGET, starting at bit offset TARG_OFFSET. SOURCE and TARGET must
2163 not overlap. */
2164 static void
2165 move_bits (gdb_byte *target, int targ_offset, const gdb_byte *source,
2166 int src_offset, int n)
2167 {
2168 unsigned int accum, mask;
2169 int accum_bits, chunk_size;
2170
2171 target += targ_offset / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2172 targ_offset %= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2173 source += src_offset / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2174 src_offset %= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2175 if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (current_gdbarch))
2176 {
2177 accum = (unsigned char) *source;
2178 source += 1;
2179 accum_bits = HOST_CHAR_BIT - src_offset;
2180
2181 while (n > 0)
2182 {
2183 int unused_right;
2184 accum = (accum << HOST_CHAR_BIT) + (unsigned char) *source;
2185 accum_bits += HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2186 source += 1;
2187 chunk_size = HOST_CHAR_BIT - targ_offset;
2188 if (chunk_size > n)
2189 chunk_size = n;
2190 unused_right = HOST_CHAR_BIT - (chunk_size + targ_offset);
2191 mask = ((1 << chunk_size) - 1) << unused_right;
2192 *target =
2193 (*target & ~mask)
2194 | ((accum >> (accum_bits - chunk_size - unused_right)) & mask);
2195 n -= chunk_size;
2196 accum_bits -= chunk_size;
2197 target += 1;
2198 targ_offset = 0;
2199 }
2200 }
2201 else
2202 {
2203 accum = (unsigned char) *source >> src_offset;
2204 source += 1;
2205 accum_bits = HOST_CHAR_BIT - src_offset;
2206
2207 while (n > 0)
2208 {
2209 accum = accum + ((unsigned char) *source << accum_bits);
2210 accum_bits += HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2211 source += 1;
2212 chunk_size = HOST_CHAR_BIT - targ_offset;
2213 if (chunk_size > n)
2214 chunk_size = n;
2215 mask = ((1 << chunk_size) - 1) << targ_offset;
2216 *target = (*target & ~mask) | ((accum << targ_offset) & mask);
2217 n -= chunk_size;
2218 accum_bits -= chunk_size;
2219 accum >>= chunk_size;
2220 target += 1;
2221 targ_offset = 0;
2222 }
2223 }
2224 }
2225
2226 /* Store the contents of FROMVAL into the location of TOVAL.
2227 Return a new value with the location of TOVAL and contents of
2228 FROMVAL. Handles assignment into packed fields that have
2229 floating-point or non-scalar types. */
2230
2231 static struct value *
2232 ada_value_assign (struct value *toval, struct value *fromval)
2233 {
2234 struct type *type = value_type (toval);
2235 int bits = value_bitsize (toval);
2236
2237 toval = ada_coerce_ref (toval);
2238 fromval = ada_coerce_ref (fromval);
2239
2240 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (toval)))
2241 toval = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (toval);
2242 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (fromval)))
2243 fromval = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (fromval);
2244
2245 if (!deprecated_value_modifiable (toval))
2246 error (_("Left operand of assignment is not a modifiable lvalue."));
2247
2248 if (VALUE_LVAL (toval) == lval_memory
2249 && bits > 0
2250 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_FLT
2251 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT))
2252 {
2253 int len = (value_bitpos (toval)
2254 + bits + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2255 char *buffer = (char *) alloca (len);
2256 struct value *val;
2257 CORE_ADDR to_addr = VALUE_ADDRESS (toval) + value_offset (toval);
2258
2259 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_FLT)
2260 fromval = value_cast (type, fromval);
2261
2262 read_memory (to_addr, buffer, len);
2263 if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (current_gdbarch))
2264 move_bits (buffer, value_bitpos (toval),
2265 value_contents (fromval),
2266 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (fromval)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT -
2267 bits, bits);
2268 else
2269 move_bits (buffer, value_bitpos (toval), value_contents (fromval),
2270 0, bits);
2271 write_memory (to_addr, buffer, len);
2272 if (deprecated_memory_changed_hook)
2273 deprecated_memory_changed_hook (to_addr, len);
2274
2275 val = value_copy (toval);
2276 memcpy (value_contents_raw (val), value_contents (fromval),
2277 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
2278 deprecated_set_value_type (val, type);
2279
2280 return val;
2281 }
2282
2283 return value_assign (toval, fromval);
2284 }
2285
2286
2287 /* Given that COMPONENT is a memory lvalue that is part of the lvalue
2288 * CONTAINER, assign the contents of VAL to COMPONENTS's place in
2289 * CONTAINER. Modifies the VALUE_CONTENTS of CONTAINER only, not
2290 * COMPONENT, and not the inferior's memory. The current contents
2291 * of COMPONENT are ignored. */
2292 static void
2293 value_assign_to_component (struct value *container, struct value *component,
2294 struct value *val)
2295 {
2296 LONGEST offset_in_container =
2297 (LONGEST) (VALUE_ADDRESS (component) + value_offset (component)
2298 - VALUE_ADDRESS (container) - value_offset (container));
2299 int bit_offset_in_container =
2300 value_bitpos (component) - value_bitpos (container);
2301 int bits;
2302
2303 val = value_cast (value_type (component), val);
2304
2305 if (value_bitsize (component) == 0)
2306 bits = TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (component));
2307 else
2308 bits = value_bitsize (component);
2309
2310 if (gdbarch_bits_big_endian (current_gdbarch))
2311 move_bits (value_contents_writeable (container) + offset_in_container,
2312 value_bitpos (container) + bit_offset_in_container,
2313 value_contents (val),
2314 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (component)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT - bits,
2315 bits);
2316 else
2317 move_bits (value_contents_writeable (container) + offset_in_container,
2318 value_bitpos (container) + bit_offset_in_container,
2319 value_contents (val), 0, bits);
2320 }
2321
2322 /* The value of the element of array ARR at the ARITY indices given in IND.
2323 ARR may be either a simple array, GNAT array descriptor, or pointer
2324 thereto. */
2325
2326 struct value *
2327 ada_value_subscript (struct value *arr, int arity, struct value **ind)
2328 {
2329 int k;
2330 struct value *elt;
2331 struct type *elt_type;
2332
2333 elt = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arr);
2334
2335 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (elt));
2336 if (TYPE_CODE (elt_type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
2337 && TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) > 0)
2338 return value_subscript_packed (elt, arity, ind);
2339
2340 for (k = 0; k < arity; k += 1)
2341 {
2342 if (TYPE_CODE (elt_type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2343 error (_("too many subscripts (%d expected)"), k);
2344 elt = value_subscript (elt, value_pos_atr (ind[k]));
2345 }
2346 return elt;
2347 }
2348
2349 /* Assuming ARR is a pointer to a standard GDB array of type TYPE, the
2350 value of the element of *ARR at the ARITY indices given in
2351 IND. Does not read the entire array into memory. */
2352
2353 struct value *
2354 ada_value_ptr_subscript (struct value *arr, struct type *type, int arity,
2355 struct value **ind)
2356 {
2357 int k;
2358
2359 for (k = 0; k < arity; k += 1)
2360 {
2361 LONGEST lwb, upb;
2362 struct value *idx;
2363
2364 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2365 error (_("too many subscripts (%d expected)"), k);
2366 arr = value_cast (lookup_pointer_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)),
2367 value_copy (arr));
2368 get_discrete_bounds (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type), &lwb, &upb);
2369 idx = value_pos_atr (ind[k]);
2370 if (lwb != 0)
2371 idx = value_sub (idx, value_from_longest (builtin_type_int, lwb));
2372 arr = value_add (arr, idx);
2373 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2374 }
2375
2376 return value_ind (arr);
2377 }
2378
2379 /* Given that ARRAY_PTR is a pointer or reference to an array of type TYPE (the
2380 actual type of ARRAY_PTR is ignored), returns a reference to
2381 the Ada slice of HIGH-LOW+1 elements starting at index LOW. The lower
2382 bound of this array is LOW, as per Ada rules. */
2383 static struct value *
2384 ada_value_slice_ptr (struct value *array_ptr, struct type *type,
2385 int low, int high)
2386 {
2387 CORE_ADDR base = value_as_address (array_ptr)
2388 + ((low - TYPE_LOW_BOUND (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type)))
2389 * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)));
2390 struct type *index_type =
2391 create_range_type (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type)),
2392 low, high);
2393 struct type *slice_type =
2394 create_array_type (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), index_type);
2395 return value_from_pointer (lookup_reference_type (slice_type), base);
2396 }
2397
2398
2399 static struct value *
2400 ada_value_slice (struct value *array, int low, int high)
2401 {
2402 struct type *type = value_type (array);
2403 struct type *index_type =
2404 create_range_type (NULL, TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type), low, high);
2405 struct type *slice_type =
2406 create_array_type (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), index_type);
2407 return value_cast (slice_type, value_slice (array, low, high - low + 1));
2408 }
2409
2410 /* If type is a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array
2411 descriptor, returns the number of dimensions for type. If arr is a
2412 simple array, returns the number of "array of"s that prefix its
2413 type designation. Otherwise, returns 0. */
2414
2415 int
2416 ada_array_arity (struct type *type)
2417 {
2418 int arity;
2419
2420 if (type == NULL)
2421 return 0;
2422
2423 type = desc_base_type (type);
2424
2425 arity = 0;
2426 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
2427 return desc_arity (desc_bounds_type (type));
2428 else
2429 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2430 {
2431 arity += 1;
2432 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
2433 }
2434
2435 return arity;
2436 }
2437
2438 /* If TYPE is a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array
2439 descriptor or a simple array type, returns the element type for
2440 TYPE after indexing by NINDICES indices, or by all indices if
2441 NINDICES is -1. Otherwise, returns NULL. */
2442
2443 struct type *
2444 ada_array_element_type (struct type *type, int nindices)
2445 {
2446 type = desc_base_type (type);
2447
2448 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
2449 {
2450 int k;
2451 struct type *p_array_type;
2452
2453 p_array_type = desc_data_type (type);
2454
2455 k = ada_array_arity (type);
2456 if (k == 0)
2457 return NULL;
2458
2459 /* Initially p_array_type = elt_type(*)[]...(k times)...[]. */
2460 if (nindices >= 0 && k > nindices)
2461 k = nindices;
2462 p_array_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (p_array_type);
2463 while (k > 0 && p_array_type != NULL)
2464 {
2465 p_array_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (p_array_type));
2466 k -= 1;
2467 }
2468 return p_array_type;
2469 }
2470 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2471 {
2472 while (nindices != 0 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2473 {
2474 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2475 nindices -= 1;
2476 }
2477 return type;
2478 }
2479
2480 return NULL;
2481 }
2482
2483 /* The type of nth index in arrays of given type (n numbering from 1).
2484 Does not examine memory. */
2485
2486 struct type *
2487 ada_index_type (struct type *type, int n)
2488 {
2489 struct type *result_type;
2490
2491 type = desc_base_type (type);
2492
2493 if (n > ada_array_arity (type))
2494 return NULL;
2495
2496 if (ada_is_simple_array_type (type))
2497 {
2498 int i;
2499
2500 for (i = 1; i < n; i += 1)
2501 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2502 result_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0));
2503 /* FIXME: The stabs type r(0,0);bound;bound in an array type
2504 has a target type of TYPE_CODE_UNDEF. We compensate here, but
2505 perhaps stabsread.c would make more sense. */
2506 if (result_type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (result_type) == TYPE_CODE_UNDEF)
2507 result_type = builtin_type_int;
2508
2509 return result_type;
2510 }
2511 else
2512 return desc_index_type (desc_bounds_type (type), n);
2513 }
2514
2515 /* Given that arr is an array type, returns the lower bound of the
2516 Nth index (numbering from 1) if WHICH is 0, and the upper bound if
2517 WHICH is 1. This returns bounds 0 .. -1 if ARR_TYPE is an
2518 array-descriptor type. If TYPEP is non-null, *TYPEP is set to the
2519 bounds type. It works for other arrays with bounds supplied by
2520 run-time quantities other than discriminants. */
2521
2522 static LONGEST
2523 ada_array_bound_from_type (struct type * arr_type, int n, int which,
2524 struct type ** typep)
2525 {
2526 struct type *type;
2527 struct type *index_type_desc;
2528
2529 if (ada_is_packed_array_type (arr_type))
2530 arr_type = decode_packed_array_type (arr_type);
2531
2532 if (arr_type == NULL || !ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type))
2533 {
2534 if (typep != NULL)
2535 *typep = builtin_type_int;
2536 return (LONGEST) - which;
2537 }
2538
2539 if (TYPE_CODE (arr_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
2540 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (arr_type);
2541 else
2542 type = arr_type;
2543
2544 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XA");
2545 if (index_type_desc == NULL)
2546 {
2547 struct type *index_type;
2548
2549 while (n > 1)
2550 {
2551 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2552 n -= 1;
2553 }
2554
2555 index_type = TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type);
2556 if (typep != NULL)
2557 *typep = index_type;
2558
2559 /* The index type is either a range type or an enumerated type.
2560 For the range type, we have some macros that allow us to
2561 extract the value of the low and high bounds. But they
2562 do now work for enumerated types. The expressions used
2563 below work for both range and enum types. */
2564 return
2565 (LONGEST) (which == 0
2566 ? TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (index_type, 0)
2567 : TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (index_type,
2568 TYPE_NFIELDS (index_type) - 1));
2569 }
2570 else
2571 {
2572 struct type *index_type =
2573 to_fixed_range_type (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (index_type_desc, n - 1),
2574 NULL, TYPE_OBJFILE (arr_type));
2575
2576 if (typep != NULL)
2577 *typep = index_type;
2578
2579 return
2580 (LONGEST) (which == 0
2581 ? TYPE_LOW_BOUND (index_type)
2582 : TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (index_type));
2583 }
2584 }
2585
2586 /* Given that arr is an array value, returns the lower bound of the
2587 nth index (numbering from 1) if WHICH is 0, and the upper bound if
2588 WHICH is 1. This routine will also work for arrays with bounds
2589 supplied by run-time quantities other than discriminants. */
2590
2591 struct value *
2592 ada_array_bound (struct value *arr, int n, int which)
2593 {
2594 struct type *arr_type = value_type (arr);
2595
2596 if (ada_is_packed_array_type (arr_type))
2597 return ada_array_bound (decode_packed_array (arr), n, which);
2598 else if (ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type))
2599 {
2600 struct type *type;
2601 LONGEST v = ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, which, &type);
2602 return value_from_longest (type, v);
2603 }
2604 else
2605 return desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr), n, which);
2606 }
2607
2608 /* Given that arr is an array value, returns the length of the
2609 nth index. This routine will also work for arrays with bounds
2610 supplied by run-time quantities other than discriminants.
2611 Does not work for arrays indexed by enumeration types with representation
2612 clauses at the moment. */
2613
2614 struct value *
2615 ada_array_length (struct value *arr, int n)
2616 {
2617 struct type *arr_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
2618
2619 if (ada_is_packed_array_type (arr_type))
2620 return ada_array_length (decode_packed_array (arr), n);
2621
2622 if (ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type))
2623 {
2624 struct type *type;
2625 LONGEST v =
2626 ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, 1, &type) -
2627 ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, 0, NULL) + 1;
2628 return value_from_longest (type, v);
2629 }
2630 else
2631 return
2632 value_from_longest (builtin_type_int,
2633 value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr),
2634 n, 1))
2635 - value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr),
2636 n, 0)) + 1);
2637 }
2638
2639 /* An empty array whose type is that of ARR_TYPE (an array type),
2640 with bounds LOW to LOW-1. */
2641
2642 static struct value *
2643 empty_array (struct type *arr_type, int low)
2644 {
2645 struct type *index_type =
2646 create_range_type (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (arr_type)),
2647 low, low - 1);
2648 struct type *elt_type = ada_array_element_type (arr_type, 1);
2649 return allocate_value (create_array_type (NULL, elt_type, index_type));
2650 }
2651 \f
2652
2653 /* Name resolution */
2654
2655 /* The "decoded" name for the user-definable Ada operator corresponding
2656 to OP. */
2657
2658 static const char *
2659 ada_decoded_op_name (enum exp_opcode op)
2660 {
2661 int i;
2662
2663 for (i = 0; ada_opname_table[i].encoded != NULL; i += 1)
2664 {
2665 if (ada_opname_table[i].op == op)
2666 return ada_opname_table[i].decoded;
2667 }
2668 error (_("Could not find operator name for opcode"));
2669 }
2670
2671
2672 /* Same as evaluate_type (*EXP), but resolves ambiguous symbol
2673 references (marked by OP_VAR_VALUE nodes in which the symbol has an
2674 undefined namespace) and converts operators that are
2675 user-defined into appropriate function calls. If CONTEXT_TYPE is
2676 non-null, it provides a preferred result type [at the moment, only
2677 type void has any effect---causing procedures to be preferred over
2678 functions in calls]. A null CONTEXT_TYPE indicates that a non-void
2679 return type is preferred. May change (expand) *EXP. */
2680
2681 static void
2682 resolve (struct expression **expp, int void_context_p)
2683 {
2684 int pc;
2685 pc = 0;
2686 resolve_subexp (expp, &pc, 1, void_context_p ? builtin_type_void : NULL);
2687 }
2688
2689 /* Resolve the operator of the subexpression beginning at
2690 position *POS of *EXPP. "Resolving" consists of replacing
2691 the symbols that have undefined namespaces in OP_VAR_VALUE nodes
2692 with their resolutions, replacing built-in operators with
2693 function calls to user-defined operators, where appropriate, and,
2694 when DEPROCEDURE_P is non-zero, converting function-valued variables
2695 into parameterless calls. May expand *EXPP. The CONTEXT_TYPE functions
2696 are as in ada_resolve, above. */
2697
2698 static struct value *
2699 resolve_subexp (struct expression **expp, int *pos, int deprocedure_p,
2700 struct type *context_type)
2701 {
2702 int pc = *pos;
2703 int i;
2704 struct expression *exp; /* Convenience: == *expp. */
2705 enum exp_opcode op = (*expp)->elts[pc].opcode;
2706 struct value **argvec; /* Vector of operand types (alloca'ed). */
2707 int nargs; /* Number of operands. */
2708 int oplen;
2709
2710 argvec = NULL;
2711 nargs = 0;
2712 exp = *expp;
2713
2714 /* Pass one: resolve operands, saving their types and updating *pos,
2715 if needed. */
2716 switch (op)
2717 {
2718 case OP_FUNCALL:
2719 if (exp->elts[pc + 3].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE
2720 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
2721 *pos += 7;
2722 else
2723 {
2724 *pos += 3;
2725 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL);
2726 }
2727 nargs = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
2728 break;
2729
2730 case UNOP_ADDR:
2731 *pos += 1;
2732 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL);
2733 break;
2734
2735 case UNOP_QUAL:
2736 *pos += 3;
2737 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, exp->elts[pc + 1].type);
2738 break;
2739
2740 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
2741 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
2742 case OP_ATR_TAG:
2743 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
2744 case OP_ATR_LAST:
2745 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
2746 case OP_ATR_POS:
2747 case OP_ATR_VAL:
2748 case OP_ATR_MIN:
2749 case OP_ATR_MAX:
2750 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
2751 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
2752 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
2753 case OP_AGGREGATE:
2754 case OP_OTHERS:
2755 case OP_CHOICES:
2756 case OP_POSITIONAL:
2757 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
2758 case OP_NAME:
2759 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs);
2760 *pos += oplen;
2761 break;
2762
2763 case BINOP_ASSIGN:
2764 {
2765 struct value *arg1;
2766
2767 *pos += 1;
2768 arg1 = resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL);
2769 if (arg1 == NULL)
2770 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, NULL);
2771 else
2772 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, value_type (arg1));
2773 break;
2774 }
2775
2776 case UNOP_CAST:
2777 *pos += 3;
2778 nargs = 1;
2779 break;
2780
2781 case BINOP_ADD:
2782 case BINOP_SUB:
2783 case BINOP_MUL:
2784 case BINOP_DIV:
2785 case BINOP_REM:
2786 case BINOP_MOD:
2787 case BINOP_EXP:
2788 case BINOP_CONCAT:
2789 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
2790 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
2791 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
2792 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
2793 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
2794
2795 case BINOP_EQUAL:
2796 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
2797 case BINOP_LESS:
2798 case BINOP_GTR:
2799 case BINOP_LEQ:
2800 case BINOP_GEQ:
2801
2802 case BINOP_REPEAT:
2803 case BINOP_SUBSCRIPT:
2804 case BINOP_COMMA:
2805 *pos += 1;
2806 nargs = 2;
2807 break;
2808
2809 case UNOP_NEG:
2810 case UNOP_PLUS:
2811 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
2812 case UNOP_ABS:
2813 case UNOP_IND:
2814 *pos += 1;
2815 nargs = 1;
2816 break;
2817
2818 case OP_LONG:
2819 case OP_DOUBLE:
2820 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
2821 *pos += 4;
2822 break;
2823
2824 case OP_TYPE:
2825 case OP_BOOL:
2826 case OP_LAST:
2827 case OP_INTERNALVAR:
2828 *pos += 3;
2829 break;
2830
2831 case UNOP_MEMVAL:
2832 *pos += 3;
2833 nargs = 1;
2834 break;
2835
2836 case OP_REGISTER:
2837 *pos += 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst + 1);
2838 break;
2839
2840 case STRUCTOP_STRUCT:
2841 *pos += 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst + 1);
2842 nargs = 1;
2843 break;
2844
2845 case TERNOP_SLICE:
2846 *pos += 1;
2847 nargs = 3;
2848 break;
2849
2850 case OP_STRING:
2851 break;
2852
2853 default:
2854 error (_("Unexpected operator during name resolution"));
2855 }
2856
2857 argvec = (struct value * *) alloca (sizeof (struct value *) * (nargs + 1));
2858 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1)
2859 argvec[i] = resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, NULL);
2860 argvec[i] = NULL;
2861 exp = *expp;
2862
2863 /* Pass two: perform any resolution on principal operator. */
2864 switch (op)
2865 {
2866 default:
2867 break;
2868
2869 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
2870 if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
2871 {
2872 struct ada_symbol_info *candidates;
2873 int n_candidates;
2874
2875 n_candidates =
2876 ada_lookup_symbol_list (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME
2877 (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol),
2878 exp->elts[pc + 1].block, VAR_DOMAIN,
2879 &candidates);
2880
2881 if (n_candidates > 1)
2882 {
2883 /* Types tend to get re-introduced locally, so if there
2884 are any local symbols that are not types, first filter
2885 out all types. */
2886 int j;
2887 for (j = 0; j < n_candidates; j += 1)
2888 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (candidates[j].sym))
2889 {
2890 case LOC_REGISTER:
2891 case LOC_ARG:
2892 case LOC_REF_ARG:
2893 case LOC_REGPARM_ADDR:
2894 case LOC_LOCAL:
2895 case LOC_COMPUTED:
2896 goto FoundNonType;
2897 default:
2898 break;
2899 }
2900 FoundNonType:
2901 if (j < n_candidates)
2902 {
2903 j = 0;
2904 while (j < n_candidates)
2905 {
2906 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (candidates[j].sym) == LOC_TYPEDEF)
2907 {
2908 candidates[j] = candidates[n_candidates - 1];
2909 n_candidates -= 1;
2910 }
2911 else
2912 j += 1;
2913 }
2914 }
2915 }
2916
2917 if (n_candidates == 0)
2918 error (_("No definition found for %s"),
2919 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
2920 else if (n_candidates == 1)
2921 i = 0;
2922 else if (deprocedure_p
2923 && !is_nonfunction (candidates, n_candidates))
2924 {
2925 i = ada_resolve_function
2926 (candidates, n_candidates, NULL, 0,
2927 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol),
2928 context_type);
2929 if (i < 0)
2930 error (_("Could not find a match for %s"),
2931 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
2932 }
2933 else
2934 {
2935 printf_filtered (_("Multiple matches for %s\n"),
2936 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
2937 user_select_syms (candidates, n_candidates, 1);
2938 i = 0;
2939 }
2940
2941 exp->elts[pc + 1].block = candidates[i].block;
2942 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol = candidates[i].sym;
2943 if (innermost_block == NULL
2944 || contained_in (candidates[i].block, innermost_block))
2945 innermost_block = candidates[i].block;
2946 }
2947
2948 if (deprocedure_p
2949 && (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol))
2950 == TYPE_CODE_FUNC))
2951 {
2952 replace_operator_with_call (expp, pc, 0, 0,
2953 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol,
2954 exp->elts[pc + 1].block);
2955 exp = *expp;
2956 }
2957 break;
2958
2959 case OP_FUNCALL:
2960 {
2961 if (exp->elts[pc + 3].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE
2962 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
2963 {
2964 struct ada_symbol_info *candidates;
2965 int n_candidates;
2966
2967 n_candidates =
2968 ada_lookup_symbol_list (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME
2969 (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol),
2970 exp->elts[pc + 4].block, VAR_DOMAIN,
2971 &candidates);
2972 if (n_candidates == 1)
2973 i = 0;
2974 else
2975 {
2976 i = ada_resolve_function
2977 (candidates, n_candidates,
2978 argvec, nargs,
2979 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol),
2980 context_type);
2981 if (i < 0)
2982 error (_("Could not find a match for %s"),
2983 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol));
2984 }
2985
2986 exp->elts[pc + 4].block = candidates[i].block;
2987 exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol = candidates[i].sym;
2988 if (innermost_block == NULL
2989 || contained_in (candidates[i].block, innermost_block))
2990 innermost_block = candidates[i].block;
2991 }
2992 }
2993 break;
2994 case BINOP_ADD:
2995 case BINOP_SUB:
2996 case BINOP_MUL:
2997 case BINOP_DIV:
2998 case BINOP_REM:
2999 case BINOP_MOD:
3000 case BINOP_CONCAT:
3001 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
3002 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
3003 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
3004 case BINOP_EQUAL:
3005 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
3006 case BINOP_LESS:
3007 case BINOP_GTR:
3008 case BINOP_LEQ:
3009 case BINOP_GEQ:
3010 case BINOP_EXP:
3011 case UNOP_NEG:
3012 case UNOP_PLUS:
3013 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
3014 case UNOP_ABS:
3015 if (possible_user_operator_p (op, argvec))
3016 {
3017 struct ada_symbol_info *candidates;
3018 int n_candidates;
3019
3020 n_candidates =
3021 ada_lookup_symbol_list (ada_encode (ada_decoded_op_name (op)),
3022 (struct block *) NULL, VAR_DOMAIN,
3023 &candidates);
3024 i = ada_resolve_function (candidates, n_candidates, argvec, nargs,
3025 ada_decoded_op_name (op), NULL);
3026 if (i < 0)
3027 break;
3028
3029 replace_operator_with_call (expp, pc, nargs, 1,
3030 candidates[i].sym, candidates[i].block);
3031 exp = *expp;
3032 }
3033 break;
3034
3035 case OP_TYPE:
3036 case OP_REGISTER:
3037 return NULL;
3038 }
3039
3040 *pos = pc;
3041 return evaluate_subexp_type (exp, pos);
3042 }
3043
3044 /* Return non-zero if formal type FTYPE matches actual type ATYPE. If
3045 MAY_DEREF is non-zero, the formal may be a pointer and the actual
3046 a non-pointer. A type of 'void' (which is never a valid expression type)
3047 by convention matches anything. */
3048 /* The term "match" here is rather loose. The match is heuristic and
3049 liberal. FIXME: TOO liberal, in fact. */
3050
3051 static int
3052 ada_type_match (struct type *ftype, struct type *atype, int may_deref)
3053 {
3054 ftype = ada_check_typedef (ftype);
3055 atype = ada_check_typedef (atype);
3056
3057 if (TYPE_CODE (ftype) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
3058 ftype = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype);
3059 if (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
3060 atype = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (atype);
3061
3062 if (TYPE_CODE (ftype) == TYPE_CODE_VOID
3063 || TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_VOID)
3064 return 1;
3065
3066 switch (TYPE_CODE (ftype))
3067 {
3068 default:
3069 return 1;
3070 case TYPE_CODE_PTR:
3071 if (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
3072 return ada_type_match (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype),
3073 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (atype), 0);
3074 else
3075 return (may_deref
3076 && ada_type_match (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype), atype, 0));
3077 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3078 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3079 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3080 switch (TYPE_CODE (atype))
3081 {
3082 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3083 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3084 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3085 return 1;
3086 default:
3087 return 0;
3088 }
3089
3090 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
3091 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
3092 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype));
3093
3094 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
3095 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (ftype))
3096 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
3097 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype));
3098 else
3099 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
3100 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype));
3101
3102 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
3103 case TYPE_CODE_FLT:
3104 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE (ftype));
3105 }
3106 }
3107
3108 /* Return non-zero if the formals of FUNC "sufficiently match" the
3109 vector of actual argument types ACTUALS of size N_ACTUALS. FUNC
3110 may also be an enumeral, in which case it is treated as a 0-
3111 argument function. */
3112
3113 static int
3114 ada_args_match (struct symbol *func, struct value **actuals, int n_actuals)
3115 {
3116 int i;
3117 struct type *func_type = SYMBOL_TYPE (func);
3118
3119 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (func) == LOC_CONST
3120 && TYPE_CODE (func_type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
3121 return (n_actuals == 0);
3122 else if (func_type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (func_type) != TYPE_CODE_FUNC)
3123 return 0;
3124
3125 if (TYPE_NFIELDS (func_type) != n_actuals)
3126 return 0;
3127
3128 for (i = 0; i < n_actuals; i += 1)
3129 {
3130 if (actuals[i] == NULL)
3131 return 0;
3132 else
3133 {
3134 struct type *ftype = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (func_type, i));
3135 struct type *atype = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actuals[i]));
3136
3137 if (!ada_type_match (ftype, atype, 1))
3138 return 0;
3139 }
3140 }
3141 return 1;
3142 }
3143
3144 /* False iff function type FUNC_TYPE definitely does not produce a value
3145 compatible with type CONTEXT_TYPE. Conservatively returns 1 if
3146 FUNC_TYPE is not a valid function type with a non-null return type
3147 or an enumerated type. A null CONTEXT_TYPE indicates any non-void type. */
3148
3149 static int
3150 return_match (struct type *func_type, struct type *context_type)
3151 {
3152 struct type *return_type;
3153
3154 if (func_type == NULL)
3155 return 1;
3156
3157 if (TYPE_CODE (func_type) == TYPE_CODE_FUNC)
3158 return_type = base_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (func_type));
3159 else
3160 return_type = base_type (func_type);
3161 if (return_type == NULL)
3162 return 1;
3163
3164 context_type = base_type (context_type);
3165
3166 if (TYPE_CODE (return_type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
3167 return context_type == NULL || return_type == context_type;
3168 else if (context_type == NULL)
3169 return TYPE_CODE (return_type) != TYPE_CODE_VOID;
3170 else
3171 return TYPE_CODE (return_type) == TYPE_CODE (context_type);
3172 }
3173
3174
3175 /* Returns the index in SYMS[0..NSYMS-1] that contains the symbol for the
3176 function (if any) that matches the types of the NARGS arguments in
3177 ARGS. If CONTEXT_TYPE is non-null and there is at least one match
3178 that returns that type, then eliminate matches that don't. If
3179 CONTEXT_TYPE is void and there is at least one match that does not
3180 return void, eliminate all matches that do.
3181
3182 Asks the user if there is more than one match remaining. Returns -1
3183 if there is no such symbol or none is selected. NAME is used
3184 solely for messages. May re-arrange and modify SYMS in
3185 the process; the index returned is for the modified vector. */
3186
3187 static int
3188 ada_resolve_function (struct ada_symbol_info syms[],
3189 int nsyms, struct value **args, int nargs,
3190 const char *name, struct type *context_type)
3191 {
3192 int k;
3193 int m; /* Number of hits */
3194 struct type *fallback;
3195 struct type *return_type;
3196
3197 return_type = context_type;
3198 if (context_type == NULL)
3199 fallback = builtin_type_void;
3200 else
3201 fallback = NULL;
3202
3203 m = 0;
3204 while (1)
3205 {
3206 for (k = 0; k < nsyms; k += 1)
3207 {
3208 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[k].sym));
3209
3210 if (ada_args_match (syms[k].sym, args, nargs)
3211 && return_match (type, return_type))
3212 {
3213 syms[m] = syms[k];
3214 m += 1;
3215 }
3216 }
3217 if (m > 0 || return_type == fallback)
3218 break;
3219 else
3220 return_type = fallback;
3221 }
3222
3223 if (m == 0)
3224 return -1;
3225 else if (m > 1)
3226 {
3227 printf_filtered (_("Multiple matches for %s\n"), name);
3228 user_select_syms (syms, m, 1);
3229 return 0;
3230 }
3231 return 0;
3232 }
3233
3234 /* Returns true (non-zero) iff decoded name N0 should appear before N1
3235 in a listing of choices during disambiguation (see sort_choices, below).
3236 The idea is that overloadings of a subprogram name from the
3237 same package should sort in their source order. We settle for ordering
3238 such symbols by their trailing number (__N or $N). */
3239
3240 static int
3241 encoded_ordered_before (char *N0, char *N1)
3242 {
3243 if (N1 == NULL)
3244 return 0;
3245 else if (N0 == NULL)
3246 return 1;
3247 else
3248 {
3249 int k0, k1;
3250 for (k0 = strlen (N0) - 1; k0 > 0 && isdigit (N0[k0]); k0 -= 1)
3251 ;
3252 for (k1 = strlen (N1) - 1; k1 > 0 && isdigit (N1[k1]); k1 -= 1)
3253 ;
3254 if ((N0[k0] == '_' || N0[k0] == '$') && N0[k0 + 1] != '\000'
3255 && (N1[k1] == '_' || N1[k1] == '$') && N1[k1 + 1] != '\000')
3256 {
3257 int n0, n1;
3258 n0 = k0;
3259 while (N0[n0] == '_' && n0 > 0 && N0[n0 - 1] == '_')
3260 n0 -= 1;
3261 n1 = k1;
3262 while (N1[n1] == '_' && n1 > 0 && N1[n1 - 1] == '_')
3263 n1 -= 1;
3264 if (n0 == n1 && strncmp (N0, N1, n0) == 0)
3265 return (atoi (N0 + k0 + 1) < atoi (N1 + k1 + 1));
3266 }
3267 return (strcmp (N0, N1) < 0);
3268 }
3269 }
3270
3271 /* Sort SYMS[0..NSYMS-1] to put the choices in a canonical order by the
3272 encoded names. */
3273
3274 static void
3275 sort_choices (struct ada_symbol_info syms[], int nsyms)
3276 {
3277 int i;
3278 for (i = 1; i < nsyms; i += 1)
3279 {
3280 struct ada_symbol_info sym = syms[i];
3281 int j;
3282
3283 for (j = i - 1; j >= 0; j -= 1)
3284 {
3285 if (encoded_ordered_before (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym),
3286 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym.sym)))
3287 break;
3288 syms[j + 1] = syms[j];
3289 }
3290 syms[j + 1] = sym;
3291 }
3292 }
3293
3294 /* Given a list of NSYMS symbols in SYMS, select up to MAX_RESULTS>0
3295 by asking the user (if necessary), returning the number selected,
3296 and setting the first elements of SYMS items. Error if no symbols
3297 selected. */
3298
3299 /* NOTE: Adapted from decode_line_2 in symtab.c, with which it ought
3300 to be re-integrated one of these days. */
3301
3302 int
3303 user_select_syms (struct ada_symbol_info *syms, int nsyms, int max_results)
3304 {
3305 int i;
3306 int *chosen = (int *) alloca (sizeof (int) * nsyms);
3307 int n_chosen;
3308 int first_choice = (max_results == 1) ? 1 : 2;
3309 const char *select_mode = multiple_symbols_select_mode ();
3310
3311 if (max_results < 1)
3312 error (_("Request to select 0 symbols!"));
3313 if (nsyms <= 1)
3314 return nsyms;
3315
3316 if (select_mode == multiple_symbols_cancel)
3317 error (_("\
3318 canceled because the command is ambiguous\n\
3319 See set/show multiple-symbol."));
3320
3321 /* If select_mode is "all", then return all possible symbols.
3322 Only do that if more than one symbol can be selected, of course.
3323 Otherwise, display the menu as usual. */
3324 if (select_mode == multiple_symbols_all && max_results > 1)
3325 return nsyms;
3326
3327 printf_unfiltered (_("[0] cancel\n"));
3328 if (max_results > 1)
3329 printf_unfiltered (_("[1] all\n"));
3330
3331 sort_choices (syms, nsyms);
3332
3333 for (i = 0; i < nsyms; i += 1)
3334 {
3335 if (syms[i].sym == NULL)
3336 continue;
3337
3338 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) == LOC_BLOCK)
3339 {
3340 struct symtab_and_line sal =
3341 find_function_start_sal (syms[i].sym, 1);
3342 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
3343 printf_unfiltered (_("[%d] %s at <no source file available>:%d\n"),
3344 i + first_choice,
3345 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym),
3346 sal.line);
3347 else
3348 printf_unfiltered (_("[%d] %s at %s:%d\n"), i + first_choice,
3349 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym),
3350 sal.symtab->filename, sal.line);
3351 continue;
3352 }
3353 else
3354 {
3355 int is_enumeral =
3356 (SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) == LOC_CONST
3357 && SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym) != NULL
3358 && TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM);
3359 struct symtab *symtab = symtab_for_sym (syms[i].sym);
3360
3361 if (SYMBOL_LINE (syms[i].sym) != 0 && symtab != NULL)
3362 printf_unfiltered (_("[%d] %s at %s:%d\n"),
3363 i + first_choice,
3364 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym),
3365 symtab->filename, SYMBOL_LINE (syms[i].sym));
3366 else if (is_enumeral
3367 && TYPE_NAME (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) != NULL)
3368 {
3369 printf_unfiltered (("[%d] "), i + first_choice);
3370 ada_print_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym), NULL,
3371 gdb_stdout, -1, 0);
3372 printf_unfiltered (_("'(%s) (enumeral)\n"),
3373 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym));
3374 }
3375 else if (symtab != NULL)
3376 printf_unfiltered (is_enumeral
3377 ? _("[%d] %s in %s (enumeral)\n")
3378 : _("[%d] %s at %s:?\n"),
3379 i + first_choice,
3380 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym),
3381 symtab->filename);
3382 else
3383 printf_unfiltered (is_enumeral
3384 ? _("[%d] %s (enumeral)\n")
3385 : _("[%d] %s at ?\n"),
3386 i + first_choice,
3387 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (syms[i].sym));
3388 }
3389 }
3390
3391 n_chosen = get_selections (chosen, nsyms, max_results, max_results > 1,
3392 "overload-choice");
3393
3394 for (i = 0; i < n_chosen; i += 1)
3395 syms[i] = syms[chosen[i]];
3396
3397 return n_chosen;
3398 }
3399
3400 /* Read and validate a set of numeric choices from the user in the
3401 range 0 .. N_CHOICES-1. Place the results in increasing
3402 order in CHOICES[0 .. N-1], and return N.
3403
3404 The user types choices as a sequence of numbers on one line
3405 separated by blanks, encoding them as follows:
3406
3407 + A choice of 0 means to cancel the selection, throwing an error.
3408 + If IS_ALL_CHOICE, a choice of 1 selects the entire set 0 .. N_CHOICES-1.
3409 + The user chooses k by typing k+IS_ALL_CHOICE+1.
3410
3411 The user is not allowed to choose more than MAX_RESULTS values.
3412
3413 ANNOTATION_SUFFIX, if present, is used to annotate the input
3414 prompts (for use with the -f switch). */
3415
3416 int
3417 get_selections (int *choices, int n_choices, int max_results,
3418 int is_all_choice, char *annotation_suffix)
3419 {
3420 char *args;
3421 char *prompt;
3422 int n_chosen;
3423 int first_choice = is_all_choice ? 2 : 1;
3424
3425 prompt = getenv ("PS2");
3426 if (prompt == NULL)
3427 prompt = "> ";
3428
3429 args = command_line_input (prompt, 0, annotation_suffix);
3430
3431 if (args == NULL)
3432 error_no_arg (_("one or more choice numbers"));
3433
3434 n_chosen = 0;
3435
3436 /* Set choices[0 .. n_chosen-1] to the users' choices in ascending
3437 order, as given in args. Choices are validated. */
3438 while (1)
3439 {
3440 char *args2;
3441 int choice, j;
3442
3443 while (isspace (*args))
3444 args += 1;
3445 if (*args == '\0' && n_chosen == 0)
3446 error_no_arg (_("one or more choice numbers"));
3447 else if (*args == '\0')
3448 break;
3449
3450 choice = strtol (args, &args2, 10);
3451 if (args == args2 || choice < 0
3452 || choice > n_choices + first_choice - 1)
3453 error (_("Argument must be choice number"));
3454 args = args2;
3455
3456 if (choice == 0)
3457 error (_("cancelled"));
3458
3459 if (choice < first_choice)
3460 {
3461 n_chosen = n_choices;
3462 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1)
3463 choices[j] = j;
3464 break;
3465 }
3466 choice -= first_choice;
3467
3468 for (j = n_chosen - 1; j >= 0 && choice < choices[j]; j -= 1)
3469 {
3470 }
3471
3472 if (j < 0 || choice != choices[j])
3473 {
3474 int k;
3475 for (k = n_chosen - 1; k > j; k -= 1)
3476 choices[k + 1] = choices[k];
3477 choices[j + 1] = choice;
3478 n_chosen += 1;
3479 }
3480 }
3481
3482 if (n_chosen > max_results)
3483 error (_("Select no more than %d of the above"), max_results);
3484
3485 return n_chosen;
3486 }
3487
3488 /* Replace the operator of length OPLEN at position PC in *EXPP with a call
3489 on the function identified by SYM and BLOCK, and taking NARGS
3490 arguments. Update *EXPP as needed to hold more space. */
3491
3492 static void
3493 replace_operator_with_call (struct expression **expp, int pc, int nargs,
3494 int oplen, struct symbol *sym,
3495 struct block *block)
3496 {
3497 /* A new expression, with 6 more elements (3 for funcall, 4 for function
3498 symbol, -oplen for operator being replaced). */
3499 struct expression *newexp = (struct expression *)
3500 xmalloc (sizeof (struct expression)
3501 + EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES ((*expp)->nelts + 7 - oplen));
3502 struct expression *exp = *expp;
3503
3504 newexp->nelts = exp->nelts + 7 - oplen;
3505 newexp->language_defn = exp->language_defn;
3506 memcpy (newexp->elts, exp->elts, EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES (pc));
3507 memcpy (newexp->elts + pc + 7, exp->elts + pc + oplen,
3508 EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES (exp->nelts - pc - oplen));
3509
3510 newexp->elts[pc].opcode = newexp->elts[pc + 2].opcode = OP_FUNCALL;
3511 newexp->elts[pc + 1].longconst = (LONGEST) nargs;
3512
3513 newexp->elts[pc + 3].opcode = newexp->elts[pc + 6].opcode = OP_VAR_VALUE;
3514 newexp->elts[pc + 4].block = block;
3515 newexp->elts[pc + 5].symbol = sym;
3516
3517 *expp = newexp;
3518 xfree (exp);
3519 }
3520
3521 /* Type-class predicates */
3522
3523 /* True iff TYPE is numeric (i.e., an INT, RANGE (of numeric type),
3524 or FLOAT). */
3525
3526 static int
3527 numeric_type_p (struct type *type)
3528 {
3529 if (type == NULL)
3530 return 0;
3531 else
3532 {
3533 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
3534 {
3535 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3536 case TYPE_CODE_FLT:
3537 return 1;
3538 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3539 return (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)
3540 || numeric_type_p (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)));
3541 default:
3542 return 0;
3543 }
3544 }
3545 }
3546
3547 /* True iff TYPE is integral (an INT or RANGE of INTs). */
3548
3549 static int
3550 integer_type_p (struct type *type)
3551 {
3552 if (type == NULL)
3553 return 0;
3554 else
3555 {
3556 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
3557 {
3558 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3559 return 1;
3560 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3561 return (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)
3562 || integer_type_p (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)));
3563 default:
3564 return 0;
3565 }
3566 }
3567 }
3568
3569 /* True iff TYPE is scalar (INT, RANGE, FLOAT, ENUM). */
3570
3571 static int
3572 scalar_type_p (struct type *type)
3573 {
3574 if (type == NULL)
3575 return 0;
3576 else
3577 {
3578 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
3579 {
3580 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3581 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3582 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3583 case TYPE_CODE_FLT:
3584 return 1;
3585 default:
3586 return 0;
3587 }
3588 }
3589 }
3590
3591 /* True iff TYPE is discrete (INT, RANGE, ENUM). */
3592
3593 static int
3594 discrete_type_p (struct type *type)
3595 {
3596 if (type == NULL)
3597 return 0;
3598 else
3599 {
3600 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
3601 {
3602 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3603 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3604 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3605 return 1;
3606 default:
3607 return 0;
3608 }
3609 }
3610 }
3611
3612 /* Returns non-zero if OP with operands in the vector ARGS could be
3613 a user-defined function. Errs on the side of pre-defined operators
3614 (i.e., result 0). */
3615
3616 static int
3617 possible_user_operator_p (enum exp_opcode op, struct value *args[])
3618 {
3619 struct type *type0 =
3620 (args[0] == NULL) ? NULL : ada_check_typedef (value_type (args[0]));
3621 struct type *type1 =
3622 (args[1] == NULL) ? NULL : ada_check_typedef (value_type (args[1]));
3623
3624 if (type0 == NULL)
3625 return 0;
3626
3627 switch (op)
3628 {
3629 default:
3630 return 0;
3631
3632 case BINOP_ADD:
3633 case BINOP_SUB:
3634 case BINOP_MUL:
3635 case BINOP_DIV:
3636 return (!(numeric_type_p (type0) && numeric_type_p (type1)));
3637
3638 case BINOP_REM:
3639 case BINOP_MOD:
3640 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
3641 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
3642 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
3643 return (!(integer_type_p (type0) && integer_type_p (type1)));
3644
3645 case BINOP_EQUAL:
3646 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
3647 case BINOP_LESS:
3648 case BINOP_GTR:
3649 case BINOP_LEQ:
3650 case BINOP_GEQ:
3651 return (!(scalar_type_p (type0) && scalar_type_p (type1)));
3652
3653 case BINOP_CONCAT:
3654 return !ada_is_array_type (type0) || !ada_is_array_type (type1);
3655
3656 case BINOP_EXP:
3657 return (!(numeric_type_p (type0) && integer_type_p (type1)));
3658
3659 case UNOP_NEG:
3660 case UNOP_PLUS:
3661 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
3662 case UNOP_ABS:
3663 return (!numeric_type_p (type0));
3664
3665 }
3666 }
3667 \f
3668 /* Renaming */
3669
3670 /* NOTES:
3671
3672 1. In the following, we assume that a renaming type's name may
3673 have an ___XD suffix. It would be nice if this went away at some
3674 point.
3675 2. We handle both the (old) purely type-based representation of
3676 renamings and the (new) variable-based encoding. At some point,
3677 it is devoutly to be hoped that the former goes away
3678 (FIXME: hilfinger-2007-07-09).
3679 3. Subprogram renamings are not implemented, although the XRS
3680 suffix is recognized (FIXME: hilfinger-2007-07-09). */
3681
3682 /* If SYM encodes a renaming,
3683
3684 <renaming> renames <renamed entity>,
3685
3686 sets *LEN to the length of the renamed entity's name,
3687 *RENAMED_ENTITY to that name (not null-terminated), and *RENAMING_EXPR to
3688 the string describing the subcomponent selected from the renamed
3689 entity. Returns ADA_NOT_RENAMING if SYM does not encode a renaming
3690 (in which case, the values of *RENAMED_ENTITY, *LEN, and *RENAMING_EXPR
3691 are undefined). Otherwise, returns a value indicating the category
3692 of entity renamed: an object (ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING), exception
3693 (ADA_EXCEPTION_RENAMING), package (ADA_PACKAGE_RENAMING), or
3694 subprogram (ADA_SUBPROGRAM_RENAMING). Does no allocation; the
3695 strings returned in *RENAMED_ENTITY and *RENAMING_EXPR should not be
3696 deallocated. The values of RENAMED_ENTITY, LEN, or RENAMING_EXPR
3697 may be NULL, in which case they are not assigned.
3698
3699 [Currently, however, GCC does not generate subprogram renamings.] */
3700
3701 enum ada_renaming_category
3702 ada_parse_renaming (struct symbol *sym,
3703 const char **renamed_entity, int *len,
3704 const char **renaming_expr)
3705 {
3706 enum ada_renaming_category kind;
3707 const char *info;
3708 const char *suffix;
3709
3710 if (sym == NULL)
3711 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3712 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym))
3713 {
3714 default:
3715 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3716 case LOC_TYPEDEF:
3717 return parse_old_style_renaming (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym),
3718 renamed_entity, len, renaming_expr);
3719 case LOC_LOCAL:
3720 case LOC_STATIC:
3721 case LOC_COMPUTED:
3722 case LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT:
3723 info = strstr (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), "___XR");
3724 if (info == NULL)
3725 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3726 switch (info[5])
3727 {
3728 case '_':
3729 kind = ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING;
3730 info += 6;
3731 break;
3732 case 'E':
3733 kind = ADA_EXCEPTION_RENAMING;
3734 info += 7;
3735 break;
3736 case 'P':
3737 kind = ADA_PACKAGE_RENAMING;
3738 info += 7;
3739 break;
3740 case 'S':
3741 kind = ADA_SUBPROGRAM_RENAMING;
3742 info += 7;
3743 break;
3744 default:
3745 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3746 }
3747 }
3748
3749 if (renamed_entity != NULL)
3750 *renamed_entity = info;
3751 suffix = strstr (info, "___XE");
3752 if (suffix == NULL || suffix == info)
3753 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3754 if (len != NULL)
3755 *len = strlen (info) - strlen (suffix);
3756 suffix += 5;
3757 if (renaming_expr != NULL)
3758 *renaming_expr = suffix;
3759 return kind;
3760 }
3761
3762 /* Assuming TYPE encodes a renaming according to the old encoding in
3763 exp_dbug.ads, returns details of that renaming in *RENAMED_ENTITY,
3764 *LEN, and *RENAMING_EXPR, as for ada_parse_renaming, above. Returns
3765 ADA_NOT_RENAMING otherwise. */
3766 static enum ada_renaming_category
3767 parse_old_style_renaming (struct type *type,
3768 const char **renamed_entity, int *len,
3769 const char **renaming_expr)
3770 {
3771 enum ada_renaming_category kind;
3772 const char *name;
3773 const char *info;
3774 const char *suffix;
3775
3776 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM
3777 || TYPE_NFIELDS (type) != 1)
3778 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3779
3780 name = type_name_no_tag (type);
3781 if (name == NULL)
3782 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3783
3784 name = strstr (name, "___XR");
3785 if (name == NULL)
3786 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3787 switch (name[5])
3788 {
3789 case '\0':
3790 case '_':
3791 kind = ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING;
3792 break;
3793 case 'E':
3794 kind = ADA_EXCEPTION_RENAMING;
3795 break;
3796 case 'P':
3797 kind = ADA_PACKAGE_RENAMING;
3798 break;
3799 case 'S':
3800 kind = ADA_SUBPROGRAM_RENAMING;
3801 break;
3802 default:
3803 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3804 }
3805
3806 info = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, 0);
3807 if (info == NULL)
3808 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3809 if (renamed_entity != NULL)
3810 *renamed_entity = info;
3811 suffix = strstr (info, "___XE");
3812 if (renaming_expr != NULL)
3813 *renaming_expr = suffix + 5;
3814 if (suffix == NULL || suffix == info)
3815 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
3816 if (len != NULL)
3817 *len = suffix - info;
3818 return kind;
3819 }
3820
3821 \f
3822
3823 /* Evaluation: Function Calls */
3824
3825 /* Return an lvalue containing the value VAL. This is the identity on
3826 lvalues, and otherwise has the side-effect of pushing a copy of VAL
3827 on the stack, using and updating *SP as the stack pointer, and
3828 returning an lvalue whose VALUE_ADDRESS points to the copy. */
3829
3830 static struct value *
3831 ensure_lval (struct value *val, CORE_ADDR *sp)
3832 {
3833 if (! VALUE_LVAL (val))
3834 {
3835 int len = TYPE_LENGTH (ada_check_typedef (value_type (val)));
3836
3837 /* The following is taken from the structure-return code in
3838 call_function_by_hand. FIXME: Therefore, some refactoring seems
3839 indicated. */
3840 if (gdbarch_inner_than (current_gdbarch, 1, 2))
3841 {
3842 /* Stack grows downward. Align SP and VALUE_ADDRESS (val) after
3843 reserving sufficient space. */
3844 *sp -= len;
3845 if (gdbarch_frame_align_p (current_gdbarch))
3846 *sp = gdbarch_frame_align (current_gdbarch, *sp);
3847 VALUE_ADDRESS (val) = *sp;
3848 }
3849 else
3850 {
3851 /* Stack grows upward. Align the frame, allocate space, and
3852 then again, re-align the frame. */
3853 if (gdbarch_frame_align_p (current_gdbarch))
3854 *sp = gdbarch_frame_align (current_gdbarch, *sp);
3855 VALUE_ADDRESS (val) = *sp;
3856 *sp += len;
3857 if (gdbarch_frame_align_p (current_gdbarch))
3858 *sp = gdbarch_frame_align (current_gdbarch, *sp);
3859 }
3860 VALUE_LVAL (val) = lval_memory;
3861
3862 write_memory (VALUE_ADDRESS (val), value_contents_raw (val), len);
3863 }
3864
3865 return val;
3866 }
3867
3868 /* Return the value ACTUAL, converted to be an appropriate value for a
3869 formal of type FORMAL_TYPE. Use *SP as a stack pointer for
3870 allocating any necessary descriptors (fat pointers), or copies of
3871 values not residing in memory, updating it as needed. */
3872
3873 struct value *
3874 ada_convert_actual (struct value *actual, struct type *formal_type0,
3875 CORE_ADDR *sp)
3876 {
3877 struct type *actual_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actual));
3878 struct type *formal_type = ada_check_typedef (formal_type0);
3879 struct type *formal_target =
3880 TYPE_CODE (formal_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
3881 ? ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (formal_type)) : formal_type;
3882 struct type *actual_target =
3883 TYPE_CODE (actual_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
3884 ? ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (actual_type)) : actual_type;
3885
3886 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (formal_target)
3887 && TYPE_CODE (actual_target) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
3888 return make_array_descriptor (formal_type, actual, sp);
3889 else if (TYPE_CODE (formal_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
3890 || TYPE_CODE (formal_type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
3891 {
3892 struct value *result;
3893 if (TYPE_CODE (formal_target) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
3894 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (actual_target))
3895 result = desc_data (actual);
3896 else if (TYPE_CODE (actual_type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR)
3897 {
3898 if (VALUE_LVAL (actual) != lval_memory)
3899 {
3900 struct value *val;
3901 actual_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actual));
3902 val = allocate_value (actual_type);
3903 memcpy ((char *) value_contents_raw (val),
3904 (char *) value_contents (actual),
3905 TYPE_LENGTH (actual_type));
3906 actual = ensure_lval (val, sp);
3907 }
3908 result = value_addr (actual);
3909 }
3910 else
3911 return actual;
3912 return value_cast_pointers (formal_type, result);
3913 }
3914 else if (TYPE_CODE (actual_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
3915 return ada_value_ind (actual);
3916
3917 return actual;
3918 }
3919
3920
3921 /* Push a descriptor of type TYPE for array value ARR on the stack at
3922 *SP, updating *SP to reflect the new descriptor. Return either
3923 an lvalue representing the new descriptor, or (if TYPE is a pointer-
3924 to-descriptor type rather than a descriptor type), a struct value *
3925 representing a pointer to this descriptor. */
3926
3927 static struct value *
3928 make_array_descriptor (struct type *type, struct value *arr, CORE_ADDR *sp)
3929 {
3930 struct type *bounds_type = desc_bounds_type (type);
3931 struct type *desc_type = desc_base_type (type);
3932 struct value *descriptor = allocate_value (desc_type);
3933 struct value *bounds = allocate_value (bounds_type);
3934 int i;
3935
3936 for (i = ada_array_arity (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr))); i > 0; i -= 1)
3937 {
3938 modify_general_field (value_contents_writeable (bounds),
3939 value_as_long (ada_array_bound (arr, i, 0)),
3940 desc_bound_bitpos (bounds_type, i, 0),
3941 desc_bound_bitsize (bounds_type, i, 0));
3942 modify_general_field (value_contents_writeable (bounds),
3943 value_as_long (ada_array_bound (arr, i, 1)),
3944 desc_bound_bitpos (bounds_type, i, 1),
3945 desc_bound_bitsize (bounds_type, i, 1));
3946 }
3947
3948 bounds = ensure_lval (bounds, sp);
3949
3950 modify_general_field (value_contents_writeable (descriptor),
3951 VALUE_ADDRESS (ensure_lval (arr, sp)),
3952 fat_pntr_data_bitpos (desc_type),
3953 fat_pntr_data_bitsize (desc_type));
3954
3955 modify_general_field (value_contents_writeable (descriptor),
3956 VALUE_ADDRESS (bounds),
3957 fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (desc_type),
3958 fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (desc_type));
3959
3960 descriptor = ensure_lval (descriptor, sp);
3961
3962 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
3963 return value_addr (descriptor);
3964 else
3965 return descriptor;
3966 }
3967 \f
3968 /* Dummy definitions for an experimental caching module that is not
3969 * used in the public sources. */
3970
3971 static int
3972 lookup_cached_symbol (const char *name, domain_enum namespace,
3973 struct symbol **sym, struct block **block)
3974 {
3975 return 0;
3976 }
3977
3978 static void
3979 cache_symbol (const char *name, domain_enum namespace, struct symbol *sym,
3980 struct block *block)
3981 {
3982 }
3983 \f
3984 /* Symbol Lookup */
3985
3986 /* Return the result of a standard (literal, C-like) lookup of NAME in
3987 given DOMAIN, visible from lexical block BLOCK. */
3988
3989 static struct symbol *
3990 standard_lookup (const char *name, const struct block *block,
3991 domain_enum domain)
3992 {
3993 struct symbol *sym;
3994
3995 if (lookup_cached_symbol (name, domain, &sym, NULL))
3996 return sym;
3997 sym = lookup_symbol_in_language (name, block, domain, language_c, 0);
3998 cache_symbol (name, domain, sym, block_found);
3999 return sym;
4000 }
4001
4002
4003 /* Non-zero iff there is at least one non-function/non-enumeral symbol
4004 in the symbol fields of SYMS[0..N-1]. We treat enumerals as functions,
4005 since they contend in overloading in the same way. */
4006 static int
4007 is_nonfunction (struct ada_symbol_info syms[], int n)
4008 {
4009 int i;
4010
4011 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1)
4012 if (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) != TYPE_CODE_FUNC
4013 && (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM
4014 || SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) != LOC_CONST))
4015 return 1;
4016
4017 return 0;
4018 }
4019
4020 /* If true (non-zero), then TYPE0 and TYPE1 represent equivalent
4021 struct types. Otherwise, they may not. */
4022
4023 static int
4024 equiv_types (struct type *type0, struct type *type1)
4025 {
4026 if (type0 == type1)
4027 return 1;
4028 if (type0 == NULL || type1 == NULL
4029 || TYPE_CODE (type0) != TYPE_CODE (type1))
4030 return 0;
4031 if ((TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
4032 || TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
4033 && ada_type_name (type0) != NULL && ada_type_name (type1) != NULL
4034 && strcmp (ada_type_name (type0), ada_type_name (type1)) == 0)
4035 return 1;
4036
4037 return 0;
4038 }
4039
4040 /* True iff SYM0 represents the same entity as SYM1, or one that is
4041 no more defined than that of SYM1. */
4042
4043 static int
4044 lesseq_defined_than (struct symbol *sym0, struct symbol *sym1)
4045 {
4046 if (sym0 == sym1)
4047 return 1;
4048 if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym0) != SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym1)
4049 || SYMBOL_CLASS (sym0) != SYMBOL_CLASS (sym1))
4050 return 0;
4051
4052 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym0))
4053 {
4054 case LOC_UNDEF:
4055 return 1;
4056 case LOC_TYPEDEF:
4057 {
4058 struct type *type0 = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym0);
4059 struct type *type1 = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym1);
4060 char *name0 = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym0);
4061 char *name1 = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym1);
4062 int len0 = strlen (name0);
4063 return
4064 TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE (type1)
4065 && (equiv_types (type0, type1)
4066 || (len0 < strlen (name1) && strncmp (name0, name1, len0) == 0
4067 && strncmp (name1 + len0, "___XV", 5) == 0));
4068 }
4069 case LOC_CONST:
4070 return SYMBOL_VALUE (sym0) == SYMBOL_VALUE (sym1)
4071 && equiv_types (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym0), SYMBOL_TYPE (sym1));
4072 default:
4073 return 0;
4074 }
4075 }
4076
4077 /* Append (SYM,BLOCK,SYMTAB) to the end of the array of struct ada_symbol_info
4078 records in OBSTACKP. Do nothing if SYM is a duplicate. */
4079
4080 static void
4081 add_defn_to_vec (struct obstack *obstackp,
4082 struct symbol *sym,
4083 struct block *block)
4084 {
4085 int i;
4086 size_t tmp;
4087 struct ada_symbol_info *prevDefns = defns_collected (obstackp, 0);
4088
4089 /* Do not try to complete stub types, as the debugger is probably
4090 already scanning all symbols matching a certain name at the
4091 time when this function is called. Trying to replace the stub
4092 type by its associated full type will cause us to restart a scan
4093 which may lead to an infinite recursion. Instead, the client
4094 collecting the matching symbols will end up collecting several
4095 matches, with at least one of them complete. It can then filter
4096 out the stub ones if needed. */
4097
4098 for (i = num_defns_collected (obstackp) - 1; i >= 0; i -= 1)
4099 {
4100 if (lesseq_defined_than (sym, prevDefns[i].sym))
4101 return;
4102 else if (lesseq_defined_than (prevDefns[i].sym, sym))
4103 {
4104 prevDefns[i].sym = sym;
4105 prevDefns[i].block = block;
4106 return;
4107 }
4108 }
4109
4110 {
4111 struct ada_symbol_info info;
4112
4113 info.sym = sym;
4114 info.block = block;
4115 obstack_grow (obstackp, &info, sizeof (struct ada_symbol_info));
4116 }
4117 }
4118
4119 /* Number of ada_symbol_info structures currently collected in
4120 current vector in *OBSTACKP. */
4121
4122 static int
4123 num_defns_collected (struct obstack *obstackp)
4124 {
4125 return obstack_object_size (obstackp) / sizeof (struct ada_symbol_info);
4126 }
4127
4128 /* Vector of ada_symbol_info structures currently collected in current
4129 vector in *OBSTACKP. If FINISH, close off the vector and return
4130 its final address. */
4131
4132 static struct ada_symbol_info *
4133 defns_collected (struct obstack *obstackp, int finish)
4134 {
4135 if (finish)
4136 return obstack_finish (obstackp);
4137 else
4138 return (struct ada_symbol_info *) obstack_base (obstackp);
4139 }
4140
4141 /* Look, in partial_symtab PST, for symbol NAME in given namespace.
4142 Check the global symbols if GLOBAL, the static symbols if not.
4143 Do wild-card match if WILD. */
4144
4145 static struct partial_symbol *
4146 ada_lookup_partial_symbol (struct partial_symtab *pst, const char *name,
4147 int global, domain_enum namespace, int wild)
4148 {
4149 struct partial_symbol **start;
4150 int name_len = strlen (name);
4151 int length = (global ? pst->n_global_syms : pst->n_static_syms);
4152 int i;
4153
4154 if (length == 0)
4155 {
4156 return (NULL);
4157 }
4158
4159 start = (global ?
4160 pst->objfile->global_psymbols.list + pst->globals_offset :
4161 pst->objfile->static_psymbols.list + pst->statics_offset);
4162
4163 if (wild)
4164 {
4165 for (i = 0; i < length; i += 1)
4166 {
4167 struct partial_symbol *psym = start[i];
4168
4169 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (psym),
4170 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (psym), namespace)
4171 && wild_match (name, name_len, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym)))
4172 return psym;
4173 }
4174 return NULL;
4175 }
4176 else
4177 {
4178 if (global)
4179 {
4180 int U;
4181 i = 0;
4182 U = length - 1;
4183 while (U - i > 4)
4184 {
4185 int M = (U + i) >> 1;
4186 struct partial_symbol *psym = start[M];
4187 if (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym)[0] < name[0])
4188 i = M + 1;
4189 else if (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym)[0] > name[0])
4190 U = M - 1;
4191 else if (strcmp (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym), name) < 0)
4192 i = M + 1;
4193 else
4194 U = M;
4195 }
4196 }
4197 else
4198 i = 0;
4199
4200 while (i < length)
4201 {
4202 struct partial_symbol *psym = start[i];
4203
4204 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (psym),
4205 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (psym), namespace))
4206 {
4207 int cmp = strncmp (name, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym), name_len);
4208
4209 if (cmp < 0)
4210 {
4211 if (global)
4212 break;
4213 }
4214 else if (cmp == 0
4215 && is_name_suffix (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym)
4216 + name_len))
4217 return psym;
4218 }
4219 i += 1;
4220 }
4221
4222 if (global)
4223 {
4224 int U;
4225 i = 0;
4226 U = length - 1;
4227 while (U - i > 4)
4228 {
4229 int M = (U + i) >> 1;
4230 struct partial_symbol *psym = start[M];
4231 if (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym)[0] < '_')
4232 i = M + 1;
4233 else if (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym)[0] > '_')
4234 U = M - 1;
4235 else if (strcmp (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym), "_ada_") < 0)
4236 i = M + 1;
4237 else
4238 U = M;
4239 }
4240 }
4241 else
4242 i = 0;
4243
4244 while (i < length)
4245 {
4246 struct partial_symbol *psym = start[i];
4247
4248 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (psym),
4249 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (psym), namespace))
4250 {
4251 int cmp;
4252
4253 cmp = (int) '_' - (int) SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym)[0];
4254 if (cmp == 0)
4255 {
4256 cmp = strncmp ("_ada_", SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym), 5);
4257 if (cmp == 0)
4258 cmp = strncmp (name, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym) + 5,
4259 name_len);
4260 }
4261
4262 if (cmp < 0)
4263 {
4264 if (global)
4265 break;
4266 }
4267 else if (cmp == 0
4268 && is_name_suffix (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (psym)
4269 + name_len + 5))
4270 return psym;
4271 }
4272 i += 1;
4273 }
4274 }
4275 return NULL;
4276 }
4277
4278 /* Find a symbol table containing symbol SYM or NULL if none. */
4279
4280 static struct symtab *
4281 symtab_for_sym (struct symbol *sym)
4282 {
4283 struct symtab *s;
4284 struct objfile *objfile;
4285 struct block *b;
4286 struct symbol *tmp_sym;
4287 struct dict_iterator iter;
4288 int j;
4289
4290 ALL_PRIMARY_SYMTABS (objfile, s)
4291 {
4292 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym))
4293 {
4294 case LOC_CONST:
4295 case LOC_STATIC:
4296 case LOC_TYPEDEF:
4297 case LOC_REGISTER:
4298 case LOC_LABEL:
4299 case LOC_BLOCK:
4300 case LOC_CONST_BYTES:
4301 b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (BLOCKVECTOR (s), GLOBAL_BLOCK);
4302 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, tmp_sym) if (sym == tmp_sym)
4303 return s;
4304 b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (BLOCKVECTOR (s), STATIC_BLOCK);
4305 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, tmp_sym) if (sym == tmp_sym)
4306 return s;
4307 break;
4308 default:
4309 break;
4310 }
4311 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym))
4312 {
4313 case LOC_REGISTER:
4314 case LOC_ARG:
4315 case LOC_REF_ARG:
4316 case LOC_REGPARM_ADDR:
4317 case LOC_LOCAL:
4318 case LOC_TYPEDEF:
4319 case LOC_COMPUTED:
4320 for (j = FIRST_LOCAL_BLOCK;
4321 j < BLOCKVECTOR_NBLOCKS (BLOCKVECTOR (s)); j += 1)
4322 {
4323 b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (BLOCKVECTOR (s), j);
4324 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, tmp_sym) if (sym == tmp_sym)
4325 return s;
4326 }
4327 break;
4328 default:
4329 break;
4330 }
4331 }
4332 return NULL;
4333 }
4334
4335 /* Return a minimal symbol matching NAME according to Ada decoding
4336 rules. Returns NULL if there is no such minimal symbol. Names
4337 prefixed with "standard__" are handled specially: "standard__" is
4338 first stripped off, and only static and global symbols are searched. */
4339
4340 struct minimal_symbol *
4341 ada_lookup_simple_minsym (const char *name)
4342 {
4343 struct objfile *objfile;
4344 struct minimal_symbol *msymbol;
4345 int wild_match;
4346
4347 if (strncmp (name, "standard__", sizeof ("standard__") - 1) == 0)
4348 {
4349 name += sizeof ("standard__") - 1;
4350 wild_match = 0;
4351 }
4352 else
4353 wild_match = (strstr (name, "__") == NULL);
4354
4355 ALL_MSYMBOLS (objfile, msymbol)
4356 {
4357 if (ada_match_name (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (msymbol), name, wild_match)
4358 && MSYMBOL_TYPE (msymbol) != mst_solib_trampoline)
4359 return msymbol;
4360 }
4361
4362 return NULL;
4363 }
4364
4365 /* For all subprograms that statically enclose the subprogram of the
4366 selected frame, add symbols matching identifier NAME in DOMAIN
4367 and their blocks to the list of data in OBSTACKP, as for
4368 ada_add_block_symbols (q.v.). If WILD, treat as NAME with a
4369 wildcard prefix. */
4370
4371 static void
4372 add_symbols_from_enclosing_procs (struct obstack *obstackp,
4373 const char *name, domain_enum namespace,
4374 int wild_match)
4375 {
4376 }
4377
4378 /* True if TYPE is definitely an artificial type supplied to a symbol
4379 for which no debugging information was given in the symbol file. */
4380
4381 static int
4382 is_nondebugging_type (struct type *type)
4383 {
4384 char *name = ada_type_name (type);
4385 return (name != NULL && strcmp (name, "<variable, no debug info>") == 0);
4386 }
4387
4388 /* Remove any non-debugging symbols in SYMS[0 .. NSYMS-1] that definitely
4389 duplicate other symbols in the list (The only case I know of where
4390 this happens is when object files containing stabs-in-ecoff are
4391 linked with files containing ordinary ecoff debugging symbols (or no
4392 debugging symbols)). Modifies SYMS to squeeze out deleted entries.
4393 Returns the number of items in the modified list. */
4394
4395 static int
4396 remove_extra_symbols (struct ada_symbol_info *syms, int nsyms)
4397 {
4398 int i, j;
4399
4400 i = 0;
4401 while (i < nsyms)
4402 {
4403 if (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].sym) != NULL
4404 && SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) == LOC_STATIC
4405 && is_nondebugging_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].sym)))
4406 {
4407 for (j = 0; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4408 {
4409 if (i != j
4410 && SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym) != NULL
4411 && strcmp (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[i].sym),
4412 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym)) == 0
4413 && SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].sym) == SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[j].sym)
4414 && SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (syms[i].sym)
4415 == SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (syms[j].sym))
4416 {
4417 int k;
4418 for (k = i + 1; k < nsyms; k += 1)
4419 syms[k - 1] = syms[k];
4420 nsyms -= 1;
4421 goto NextSymbol;
4422 }
4423 }
4424 }
4425 i += 1;
4426 NextSymbol:
4427 ;
4428 }
4429 return nsyms;
4430 }
4431
4432 /* Given a type that corresponds to a renaming entity, use the type name
4433 to extract the scope (package name or function name, fully qualified,
4434 and following the GNAT encoding convention) where this renaming has been
4435 defined. The string returned needs to be deallocated after use. */
4436
4437 static char *
4438 xget_renaming_scope (struct type *renaming_type)
4439 {
4440 /* The renaming types adhere to the following convention:
4441 <scope>__<rename>___<XR extension>.
4442 So, to extract the scope, we search for the "___XR" extension,
4443 and then backtrack until we find the first "__". */
4444
4445 const char *name = type_name_no_tag (renaming_type);
4446 char *suffix = strstr (name, "___XR");
4447 char *last;
4448 int scope_len;
4449 char *scope;
4450
4451 /* Now, backtrack a bit until we find the first "__". Start looking
4452 at suffix - 3, as the <rename> part is at least one character long. */
4453
4454 for (last = suffix - 3; last > name; last--)
4455 if (last[0] == '_' && last[1] == '_')
4456 break;
4457
4458 /* Make a copy of scope and return it. */
4459
4460 scope_len = last - name;
4461 scope = (char *) xmalloc ((scope_len + 1) * sizeof (char));
4462
4463 strncpy (scope, name, scope_len);
4464 scope[scope_len] = '\0';
4465
4466 return scope;
4467 }
4468
4469 /* Return nonzero if NAME corresponds to a package name. */
4470
4471 static int
4472 is_package_name (const char *name)
4473 {
4474 /* Here, We take advantage of the fact that no symbols are generated
4475 for packages, while symbols are generated for each function.
4476 So the condition for NAME represent a package becomes equivalent
4477 to NAME not existing in our list of symbols. There is only one
4478 small complication with library-level functions (see below). */
4479
4480 char *fun_name;
4481
4482 /* If it is a function that has not been defined at library level,
4483 then we should be able to look it up in the symbols. */
4484 if (standard_lookup (name, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN) != NULL)
4485 return 0;
4486
4487 /* Library-level function names start with "_ada_". See if function
4488 "_ada_" followed by NAME can be found. */
4489
4490 /* Do a quick check that NAME does not contain "__", since library-level
4491 functions names cannot contain "__" in them. */
4492 if (strstr (name, "__") != NULL)
4493 return 0;
4494
4495 fun_name = xstrprintf ("_ada_%s", name);
4496
4497 return (standard_lookup (fun_name, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN) == NULL);
4498 }
4499
4500 /* Return nonzero if SYM corresponds to a renaming entity that is
4501 not visible from FUNCTION_NAME. */
4502
4503 static int
4504 old_renaming_is_invisible (const struct symbol *sym, char *function_name)
4505 {
4506 char *scope;
4507
4508 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_TYPEDEF)
4509 return 0;
4510
4511 scope = xget_renaming_scope (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym));
4512
4513 make_cleanup (xfree, scope);
4514
4515 /* If the rename has been defined in a package, then it is visible. */
4516 if (is_package_name (scope))
4517 return 0;
4518
4519 /* Check that the rename is in the current function scope by checking
4520 that its name starts with SCOPE. */
4521
4522 /* If the function name starts with "_ada_", it means that it is
4523 a library-level function. Strip this prefix before doing the
4524 comparison, as the encoding for the renaming does not contain
4525 this prefix. */
4526 if (strncmp (function_name, "_ada_", 5) == 0)
4527 function_name += 5;
4528
4529 return (strncmp (function_name, scope, strlen (scope)) != 0);
4530 }
4531
4532 /* Remove entries from SYMS that corresponds to a renaming entity that
4533 is not visible from the function associated with CURRENT_BLOCK or
4534 that is superfluous due to the presence of more specific renaming
4535 information. Places surviving symbols in the initial entries of
4536 SYMS and returns the number of surviving symbols.
4537
4538 Rationale:
4539 First, in cases where an object renaming is implemented as a
4540 reference variable, GNAT may produce both the actual reference
4541 variable and the renaming encoding. In this case, we discard the
4542 latter.
4543
4544 Second, GNAT emits a type following a specified encoding for each renaming
4545 entity. Unfortunately, STABS currently does not support the definition
4546 of types that are local to a given lexical block, so all renamings types
4547 are emitted at library level. As a consequence, if an application
4548 contains two renaming entities using the same name, and a user tries to
4549 print the value of one of these entities, the result of the ada symbol
4550 lookup will also contain the wrong renaming type.
4551
4552 This function partially covers for this limitation by attempting to
4553 remove from the SYMS list renaming symbols that should be visible
4554 from CURRENT_BLOCK. However, there does not seem be a 100% reliable
4555 method with the current information available. The implementation
4556 below has a couple of limitations (FIXME: brobecker-2003-05-12):
4557
4558 - When the user tries to print a rename in a function while there
4559 is another rename entity defined in a package: Normally, the
4560 rename in the function has precedence over the rename in the
4561 package, so the latter should be removed from the list. This is
4562 currently not the case.
4563
4564 - This function will incorrectly remove valid renames if
4565 the CURRENT_BLOCK corresponds to a function which symbol name
4566 has been changed by an "Export" pragma. As a consequence,
4567 the user will be unable to print such rename entities. */
4568
4569 static int
4570 remove_irrelevant_renamings (struct ada_symbol_info *syms,
4571 int nsyms, const struct block *current_block)
4572 {
4573 struct symbol *current_function;
4574 char *current_function_name;
4575 int i;
4576 int is_new_style_renaming;
4577
4578 /* If there is both a renaming foo___XR... encoded as a variable and
4579 a simple variable foo in the same block, discard the latter.
4580 First, zero out such symbols, then compress. */
4581 is_new_style_renaming = 0;
4582 for (i = 0; i < nsyms; i += 1)
4583 {
4584 struct symbol *sym = syms[i].sym;
4585 struct block *block = syms[i].block;
4586 const char *name;
4587 const char *suffix;
4588
4589 if (sym == NULL || SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_TYPEDEF)
4590 continue;
4591 name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym);
4592 suffix = strstr (name, "___XR");
4593
4594 if (suffix != NULL)
4595 {
4596 int name_len = suffix - name;
4597 int j;
4598 is_new_style_renaming = 1;
4599 for (j = 0; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4600 if (i != j && syms[j].sym != NULL
4601 && strncmp (name, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (syms[j].sym),
4602 name_len) == 0
4603 && block == syms[j].block)
4604 syms[j].sym = NULL;
4605 }
4606 }
4607 if (is_new_style_renaming)
4608 {
4609 int j, k;
4610
4611 for (j = k = 0; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4612 if (syms[j].sym != NULL)
4613 {
4614 syms[k] = syms[j];
4615 k += 1;
4616 }
4617 return k;
4618 }
4619
4620 /* Extract the function name associated to CURRENT_BLOCK.
4621 Abort if unable to do so. */
4622
4623 if (current_block == NULL)
4624 return nsyms;
4625
4626 current_function = block_function (current_block);
4627 if (current_function == NULL)
4628 return nsyms;
4629
4630 current_function_name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (current_function);
4631 if (current_function_name == NULL)
4632 return nsyms;
4633
4634 /* Check each of the symbols, and remove it from the list if it is
4635 a type corresponding to a renaming that is out of the scope of
4636 the current block. */
4637
4638 i = 0;
4639 while (i < nsyms)
4640 {
4641 if (ada_parse_renaming (syms[i].sym, NULL, NULL, NULL)
4642 == ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING
4643 && old_renaming_is_invisible (syms[i].sym, current_function_name))
4644 {
4645 int j;
4646 for (j = i + 1; j < nsyms; j += 1)
4647 syms[j - 1] = syms[j];
4648 nsyms -= 1;
4649 }
4650 else
4651 i += 1;
4652 }
4653
4654 return nsyms;
4655 }
4656
4657 /* Find symbols in DOMAIN matching NAME0, in BLOCK0 and enclosing
4658 scope and in global scopes, returning the number of matches. Sets
4659 *RESULTS to point to a vector of (SYM,BLOCK) tuples,
4660 indicating the symbols found and the blocks and symbol tables (if
4661 any) in which they were found. This vector are transient---good only to
4662 the next call of ada_lookup_symbol_list. Any non-function/non-enumeral
4663 symbol match within the nest of blocks whose innermost member is BLOCK0,
4664 is the one match returned (no other matches in that or
4665 enclosing blocks is returned). If there are any matches in or
4666 surrounding BLOCK0, then these alone are returned. Otherwise, the
4667 search extends to global and file-scope (static) symbol tables.
4668 Names prefixed with "standard__" are handled specially: "standard__"
4669 is first stripped off, and only static and global symbols are searched. */
4670
4671 int
4672 ada_lookup_symbol_list (const char *name0, const struct block *block0,
4673 domain_enum namespace,
4674 struct ada_symbol_info **results)
4675 {
4676 struct symbol *sym;
4677 struct symtab *s;
4678 struct partial_symtab *ps;
4679 struct blockvector *bv;
4680 struct objfile *objfile;
4681 struct block *block;
4682 const char *name;
4683 struct minimal_symbol *msymbol;
4684 int wild_match;
4685 int cacheIfUnique;
4686 int block_depth;
4687 int ndefns;
4688
4689 obstack_free (&symbol_list_obstack, NULL);
4690 obstack_init (&symbol_list_obstack);
4691
4692 cacheIfUnique = 0;
4693
4694 /* Search specified block and its superiors. */
4695
4696 wild_match = (strstr (name0, "__") == NULL);
4697 name = name0;
4698 block = (struct block *) block0; /* FIXME: No cast ought to be
4699 needed, but adding const will
4700 have a cascade effect. */
4701 if (strncmp (name0, "standard__", sizeof ("standard__") - 1) == 0)
4702 {
4703 wild_match = 0;
4704 block = NULL;
4705 name = name0 + sizeof ("standard__") - 1;
4706 }
4707
4708 block_depth = 0;
4709 while (block != NULL)
4710 {
4711 block_depth += 1;
4712 ada_add_block_symbols (&symbol_list_obstack, block, name,
4713 namespace, NULL, wild_match);
4714
4715 /* If we found a non-function match, assume that's the one. */
4716 if (is_nonfunction (defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack, 0),
4717 num_defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack)))
4718 goto done;
4719
4720 block = BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (block);
4721 }
4722
4723 /* If no luck so far, try to find NAME as a local symbol in some lexically
4724 enclosing subprogram. */
4725 if (num_defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack) == 0 && block_depth > 2)
4726 add_symbols_from_enclosing_procs (&symbol_list_obstack,
4727 name, namespace, wild_match);
4728
4729 /* If we found ANY matches among non-global symbols, we're done. */
4730
4731 if (num_defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack) > 0)
4732 goto done;
4733
4734 cacheIfUnique = 1;
4735 if (lookup_cached_symbol (name0, namespace, &sym, &block))
4736 {
4737 if (sym != NULL)
4738 add_defn_to_vec (&symbol_list_obstack, sym, block);
4739 goto done;
4740 }
4741
4742 /* Now add symbols from all global blocks: symbol tables, minimal symbol
4743 tables, and psymtab's. */
4744
4745 ALL_PRIMARY_SYMTABS (objfile, s)
4746 {
4747 QUIT;
4748 bv = BLOCKVECTOR (s);
4749 block = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (bv, GLOBAL_BLOCK);
4750 ada_add_block_symbols (&symbol_list_obstack, block, name, namespace,
4751 objfile, wild_match);
4752 }
4753
4754 if (namespace == VAR_DOMAIN)
4755 {
4756 ALL_MSYMBOLS (objfile, msymbol)
4757 {
4758 if (ada_match_name (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (msymbol), name, wild_match))
4759 {
4760 switch (MSYMBOL_TYPE (msymbol))
4761 {
4762 case mst_solib_trampoline:
4763 break;
4764 default:
4765 s = find_pc_symtab (SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (msymbol));
4766 if (s != NULL)
4767 {
4768 int ndefns0 = num_defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack);
4769 QUIT;
4770 bv = BLOCKVECTOR (s);
4771 block = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (bv, GLOBAL_BLOCK);
4772 ada_add_block_symbols (&symbol_list_obstack, block,
4773 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (msymbol),
4774 namespace, objfile, wild_match);
4775
4776 if (num_defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack) == ndefns0)
4777 {
4778 block = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (bv, STATIC_BLOCK);
4779 ada_add_block_symbols (&symbol_list_obstack, block,
4780 SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (msymbol),
4781 namespace, objfile,
4782 wild_match);
4783 }
4784 }
4785 }
4786 }
4787 }
4788 }
4789
4790 ALL_PSYMTABS (objfile, ps)
4791 {
4792 QUIT;
4793 if (!ps->readin
4794 && ada_lookup_partial_symbol (ps, name, 1, namespace, wild_match))
4795 {
4796 s = PSYMTAB_TO_SYMTAB (ps);
4797 if (!s->primary)
4798 continue;
4799 bv = BLOCKVECTOR (s);
4800 block = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (bv, GLOBAL_BLOCK);
4801 ada_add_block_symbols (&symbol_list_obstack, block, name,
4802 namespace, objfile, wild_match);
4803 }
4804 }
4805
4806 /* Now add symbols from all per-file blocks if we've gotten no hits
4807 (Not strictly correct, but perhaps better than an error).
4808 Do the symtabs first, then check the psymtabs. */
4809
4810 if (num_defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack) == 0)
4811 {
4812
4813 ALL_PRIMARY_SYMTABS (objfile, s)
4814 {
4815 QUIT;
4816 bv = BLOCKVECTOR (s);
4817 block = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (bv, STATIC_BLOCK);
4818 ada_add_block_symbols (&symbol_list_obstack, block, name, namespace,
4819 objfile, wild_match);
4820 }
4821
4822 ALL_PSYMTABS (objfile, ps)
4823 {
4824 QUIT;
4825 if (!ps->readin
4826 && ada_lookup_partial_symbol (ps, name, 0, namespace, wild_match))
4827 {
4828 s = PSYMTAB_TO_SYMTAB (ps);
4829 bv = BLOCKVECTOR (s);
4830 if (!s->primary)
4831 continue;
4832 block = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (bv, STATIC_BLOCK);
4833 ada_add_block_symbols (&symbol_list_obstack, block, name,
4834 namespace, objfile, wild_match);
4835 }
4836 }
4837 }
4838
4839 done:
4840 ndefns = num_defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack);
4841 *results = defns_collected (&symbol_list_obstack, 1);
4842
4843 ndefns = remove_extra_symbols (*results, ndefns);
4844
4845 if (ndefns == 0)
4846 cache_symbol (name0, namespace, NULL, NULL);
4847
4848 if (ndefns == 1 && cacheIfUnique)
4849 cache_symbol (name0, namespace, (*results)[0].sym, (*results)[0].block);
4850
4851 ndefns = remove_irrelevant_renamings (*results, ndefns, block0);
4852
4853 return ndefns;
4854 }
4855
4856 struct symbol *
4857 ada_lookup_encoded_symbol (const char *name, const struct block *block0,
4858 domain_enum namespace, struct block **block_found)
4859 {
4860 struct ada_symbol_info *candidates;
4861 int n_candidates;
4862
4863 n_candidates = ada_lookup_symbol_list (name, block0, namespace, &candidates);
4864
4865 if (n_candidates == 0)
4866 return NULL;
4867
4868 if (block_found != NULL)
4869 *block_found = candidates[0].block;
4870
4871 return fixup_symbol_section (candidates[0].sym, NULL);
4872 }
4873
4874 /* Return a symbol in DOMAIN matching NAME, in BLOCK0 and enclosing
4875 scope and in global scopes, or NULL if none. NAME is folded and
4876 encoded first. Otherwise, the result is as for ada_lookup_symbol_list,
4877 choosing the first symbol if there are multiple choices.
4878 *IS_A_FIELD_OF_THIS is set to 0 and *SYMTAB is set to the symbol
4879 table in which the symbol was found (in both cases, these
4880 assignments occur only if the pointers are non-null). */
4881 struct symbol *
4882 ada_lookup_symbol (const char *name, const struct block *block0,
4883 domain_enum namespace, int *is_a_field_of_this)
4884 {
4885 if (is_a_field_of_this != NULL)
4886 *is_a_field_of_this = 0;
4887
4888 return
4889 ada_lookup_encoded_symbol (ada_encode (ada_fold_name (name)),
4890 block0, namespace, NULL);
4891 }
4892
4893 static struct symbol *
4894 ada_lookup_symbol_nonlocal (const char *name,
4895 const char *linkage_name,
4896 const struct block *block,
4897 const domain_enum domain)
4898 {
4899 if (linkage_name == NULL)
4900 linkage_name = name;
4901 return ada_lookup_symbol (linkage_name, block_static_block (block), domain,
4902 NULL);
4903 }
4904
4905
4906 /* True iff STR is a possible encoded suffix of a normal Ada name
4907 that is to be ignored for matching purposes. Suffixes of parallel
4908 names (e.g., XVE) are not included here. Currently, the possible suffixes
4909 are given by either of the regular expression:
4910
4911 [.$][0-9]+ [nested subprogram suffix, on platforms such as GNU/Linux]
4912 ___[0-9]+ [nested subprogram suffix, on platforms such as HP/UX]
4913 _E[0-9]+[bs]$ [protected object entry suffixes]
4914 (X[nb]*)?((\$|__)[0-9](_?[0-9]+)|___(JM|LJM|X([FDBUP].*|R[^T]?)))?$
4915
4916 Also, any leading "__[0-9]+" sequence is skipped before the suffix
4917 match is performed. This sequence is used to differentiate homonyms,
4918 is an optional part of a valid name suffix. */
4919
4920 static int
4921 is_name_suffix (const char *str)
4922 {
4923 int k;
4924 const char *matching;
4925 const int len = strlen (str);
4926
4927 /* Skip optional leading __[0-9]+. */
4928
4929 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str[1] == '_' && isdigit (str[2]))
4930 {
4931 str += 3;
4932 while (isdigit (str[0]))
4933 str += 1;
4934 }
4935
4936 /* [.$][0-9]+ */
4937
4938 if (str[0] == '.' || str[0] == '$')
4939 {
4940 matching = str + 1;
4941 while (isdigit (matching[0]))
4942 matching += 1;
4943 if (matching[0] == '\0')
4944 return 1;
4945 }
4946
4947 /* ___[0-9]+ */
4948
4949 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str[1] == '_' && str[2] == '_')
4950 {
4951 matching = str + 3;
4952 while (isdigit (matching[0]))
4953 matching += 1;
4954 if (matching[0] == '\0')
4955 return 1;
4956 }
4957
4958 #if 0
4959 /* FIXME: brobecker/2005-09-23: Protected Object subprograms end
4960 with a N at the end. Unfortunately, the compiler uses the same
4961 convention for other internal types it creates. So treating
4962 all entity names that end with an "N" as a name suffix causes
4963 some regressions. For instance, consider the case of an enumerated
4964 type. To support the 'Image attribute, it creates an array whose
4965 name ends with N.
4966 Having a single character like this as a suffix carrying some
4967 information is a bit risky. Perhaps we should change the encoding
4968 to be something like "_N" instead. In the meantime, do not do
4969 the following check. */
4970 /* Protected Object Subprograms */
4971 if (len == 1 && str [0] == 'N')
4972 return 1;
4973 #endif
4974
4975 /* _E[0-9]+[bs]$ */
4976 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str [1] == 'E' && isdigit (str[2]))
4977 {
4978 matching = str + 3;
4979 while (isdigit (matching[0]))
4980 matching += 1;
4981 if ((matching[0] == 'b' || matching[0] == 's')
4982 && matching [1] == '\0')
4983 return 1;
4984 }
4985
4986 /* ??? We should not modify STR directly, as we are doing below. This
4987 is fine in this case, but may become problematic later if we find
4988 that this alternative did not work, and want to try matching
4989 another one from the begining of STR. Since we modified it, we
4990 won't be able to find the begining of the string anymore! */
4991 if (str[0] == 'X')
4992 {
4993 str += 1;
4994 while (str[0] != '_' && str[0] != '\0')
4995 {
4996 if (str[0] != 'n' && str[0] != 'b')
4997 return 0;
4998 str += 1;
4999 }
5000 }
5001
5002 if (str[0] == '\000')
5003 return 1;
5004
5005 if (str[0] == '_')
5006 {
5007 if (str[1] != '_' || str[2] == '\000')
5008 return 0;
5009 if (str[2] == '_')
5010 {
5011 if (strcmp (str + 3, "JM") == 0)
5012 return 1;
5013 /* FIXME: brobecker/2004-09-30: GNAT will soon stop using
5014 the LJM suffix in favor of the JM one. But we will
5015 still accept LJM as a valid suffix for a reasonable
5016 amount of time, just to allow ourselves to debug programs
5017 compiled using an older version of GNAT. */
5018 if (strcmp (str + 3, "LJM") == 0)
5019 return 1;
5020 if (str[3] != 'X')
5021 return 0;
5022 if (str[4] == 'F' || str[4] == 'D' || str[4] == 'B'
5023 || str[4] == 'U' || str[4] == 'P')
5024 return 1;
5025 if (str[4] == 'R' && str[5] != 'T')
5026 return 1;
5027 return 0;
5028 }
5029 if (!isdigit (str[2]))
5030 return 0;
5031 for (k = 3; str[k] != '\0'; k += 1)
5032 if (!isdigit (str[k]) && str[k] != '_')
5033 return 0;
5034 return 1;
5035 }
5036 if (str[0] == '$' && isdigit (str[1]))
5037 {
5038 for (k = 2; str[k] != '\0'; k += 1)
5039 if (!isdigit (str[k]) && str[k] != '_')
5040 return 0;
5041 return 1;
5042 }
5043 return 0;
5044 }
5045
5046 /* Return nonzero if the given string starts with a dot ('.')
5047 followed by zero or more digits.
5048
5049 Note: brobecker/2003-11-10: A forward declaration has not been
5050 added at the begining of this file yet, because this function
5051 is only used to work around a problem found during wild matching
5052 when trying to match minimal symbol names against symbol names
5053 obtained from dwarf-2 data. This function is therefore currently
5054 only used in wild_match() and is likely to be deleted when the
5055 problem in dwarf-2 is fixed. */
5056
5057 static int
5058 is_dot_digits_suffix (const char *str)
5059 {
5060 if (str[0] != '.')
5061 return 0;
5062
5063 str++;
5064 while (isdigit (str[0]))
5065 str++;
5066 return (str[0] == '\0');
5067 }
5068
5069 /* Return non-zero if the string starting at NAME and ending before
5070 NAME_END contains no capital letters. */
5071
5072 static int
5073 is_valid_name_for_wild_match (const char *name0)
5074 {
5075 const char *decoded_name = ada_decode (name0);
5076 int i;
5077
5078 for (i=0; decoded_name[i] != '\0'; i++)
5079 if (isalpha (decoded_name[i]) && !islower (decoded_name[i]))
5080 return 0;
5081
5082 return 1;
5083 }
5084
5085 /* True if NAME represents a name of the form A1.A2....An, n>=1 and
5086 PATN[0..PATN_LEN-1] = Ak.Ak+1.....An for some k >= 1. Ignores
5087 informational suffixes of NAME (i.e., for which is_name_suffix is
5088 true). */
5089
5090 static int
5091 wild_match (const char *patn0, int patn_len, const char *name0)
5092 {
5093 int name_len;
5094 char *name;
5095 char *name_start;
5096 char *patn;
5097
5098 /* FIXME: brobecker/2003-11-10: For some reason, the symbol name
5099 stored in the symbol table for nested function names is sometimes
5100 different from the name of the associated entity stored in
5101 the dwarf-2 data: This is the case for nested subprograms, where
5102 the minimal symbol name contains a trailing ".[:digit:]+" suffix,
5103 while the symbol name from the dwarf-2 data does not.
5104
5105 Although the DWARF-2 standard documents that entity names stored
5106 in the dwarf-2 data should be identical to the name as seen in
5107 the source code, GNAT takes a different approach as we already use
5108 a special encoding mechanism to convey the information so that
5109 a C debugger can still use the information generated to debug
5110 Ada programs. A corollary is that the symbol names in the dwarf-2
5111 data should match the names found in the symbol table. I therefore
5112 consider this issue as a compiler defect.
5113
5114 Until the compiler is properly fixed, we work-around the problem
5115 by ignoring such suffixes during the match. We do so by making
5116 a copy of PATN0 and NAME0, and then by stripping such a suffix
5117 if present. We then perform the match on the resulting strings. */
5118 {
5119 char *dot;
5120 name_len = strlen (name0);
5121
5122 name = name_start = (char *) alloca ((name_len + 1) * sizeof (char));
5123 strcpy (name, name0);
5124 dot = strrchr (name, '.');
5125 if (dot != NULL && is_dot_digits_suffix (dot))
5126 *dot = '\0';
5127
5128 patn = (char *) alloca ((patn_len + 1) * sizeof (char));
5129 strncpy (patn, patn0, patn_len);
5130 patn[patn_len] = '\0';
5131 dot = strrchr (patn, '.');
5132 if (dot != NULL && is_dot_digits_suffix (dot))
5133 {
5134 *dot = '\0';
5135 patn_len = dot - patn;
5136 }
5137 }
5138
5139 /* Now perform the wild match. */
5140
5141 name_len = strlen (name);
5142 if (name_len >= patn_len + 5 && strncmp (name, "_ada_", 5) == 0
5143 && strncmp (patn, name + 5, patn_len) == 0
5144 && is_name_suffix (name + patn_len + 5))
5145 return 1;
5146
5147 while (name_len >= patn_len)
5148 {
5149 if (strncmp (patn, name, patn_len) == 0
5150 && is_name_suffix (name + patn_len))
5151 return (name == name_start || is_valid_name_for_wild_match (name0));
5152 do
5153 {
5154 name += 1;
5155 name_len -= 1;
5156 }
5157 while (name_len > 0
5158 && name[0] != '.' && (name[0] != '_' || name[1] != '_'));
5159 if (name_len <= 0)
5160 return 0;
5161 if (name[0] == '_')
5162 {
5163 if (!islower (name[2]))
5164 return 0;
5165 name += 2;
5166 name_len -= 2;
5167 }
5168 else
5169 {
5170 if (!islower (name[1]))
5171 return 0;
5172 name += 1;
5173 name_len -= 1;
5174 }
5175 }
5176
5177 return 0;
5178 }
5179
5180
5181 /* Add symbols from BLOCK matching identifier NAME in DOMAIN to
5182 vector *defn_symbols, updating the list of symbols in OBSTACKP
5183 (if necessary). If WILD, treat as NAME with a wildcard prefix.
5184 OBJFILE is the section containing BLOCK.
5185 SYMTAB is recorded with each symbol added. */
5186
5187 static void
5188 ada_add_block_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp,
5189 struct block *block, const char *name,
5190 domain_enum domain, struct objfile *objfile,
5191 int wild)
5192 {
5193 struct dict_iterator iter;
5194 int name_len = strlen (name);
5195 /* A matching argument symbol, if any. */
5196 struct symbol *arg_sym;
5197 /* Set true when we find a matching non-argument symbol. */
5198 int found_sym;
5199 struct symbol *sym;
5200
5201 arg_sym = NULL;
5202 found_sym = 0;
5203 if (wild)
5204 {
5205 struct symbol *sym;
5206 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (block, iter, sym)
5207 {
5208 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (sym),
5209 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym), domain)
5210 && wild_match (name, name_len, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym)))
5211 {
5212 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_UNRESOLVED)
5213 continue;
5214 else if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
5215 arg_sym = sym;
5216 else
5217 {
5218 found_sym = 1;
5219 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5220 fixup_symbol_section (sym, objfile),
5221 block);
5222 }
5223 }
5224 }
5225 }
5226 else
5227 {
5228 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (block, iter, sym)
5229 {
5230 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (sym),
5231 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym), domain))
5232 {
5233 int cmp = strncmp (name, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), name_len);
5234 if (cmp == 0
5235 && is_name_suffix (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym) + name_len))
5236 {
5237 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_UNRESOLVED)
5238 {
5239 if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
5240 arg_sym = sym;
5241 else
5242 {
5243 found_sym = 1;
5244 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5245 fixup_symbol_section (sym, objfile),
5246 block);
5247 }
5248 }
5249 }
5250 }
5251 }
5252 }
5253
5254 if (!found_sym && arg_sym != NULL)
5255 {
5256 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5257 fixup_symbol_section (arg_sym, objfile),
5258 block);
5259 }
5260
5261 if (!wild)
5262 {
5263 arg_sym = NULL;
5264 found_sym = 0;
5265
5266 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (block, iter, sym)
5267 {
5268 if (symbol_matches_domain (SYMBOL_LANGUAGE (sym),
5269 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym), domain))
5270 {
5271 int cmp;
5272
5273 cmp = (int) '_' - (int) SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym)[0];
5274 if (cmp == 0)
5275 {
5276 cmp = strncmp ("_ada_", SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), 5);
5277 if (cmp == 0)
5278 cmp = strncmp (name, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym) + 5,
5279 name_len);
5280 }
5281
5282 if (cmp == 0
5283 && is_name_suffix (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym) + name_len + 5))
5284 {
5285 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_UNRESOLVED)
5286 {
5287 if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
5288 arg_sym = sym;
5289 else
5290 {
5291 found_sym = 1;
5292 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5293 fixup_symbol_section (sym, objfile),
5294 block);
5295 }
5296 }
5297 }
5298 }
5299 }
5300
5301 /* NOTE: This really shouldn't be needed for _ada_ symbols.
5302 They aren't parameters, right? */
5303 if (!found_sym && arg_sym != NULL)
5304 {
5305 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
5306 fixup_symbol_section (arg_sym, objfile),
5307 block);
5308 }
5309 }
5310 }
5311 \f
5312
5313 /* Symbol Completion */
5314
5315 /* If SYM_NAME is a completion candidate for TEXT, return this symbol
5316 name in a form that's appropriate for the completion. The result
5317 does not need to be deallocated, but is only good until the next call.
5318
5319 TEXT_LEN is equal to the length of TEXT.
5320 Perform a wild match if WILD_MATCH is set.
5321 ENCODED should be set if TEXT represents the start of a symbol name
5322 in its encoded form. */
5323
5324 static const char *
5325 symbol_completion_match (const char *sym_name,
5326 const char *text, int text_len,
5327 int wild_match, int encoded)
5328 {
5329 char *result;
5330 const int verbatim_match = (text[0] == '<');
5331 int match = 0;
5332
5333 if (verbatim_match)
5334 {
5335 /* Strip the leading angle bracket. */
5336 text = text + 1;
5337 text_len--;
5338 }
5339
5340 /* First, test against the fully qualified name of the symbol. */
5341
5342 if (strncmp (sym_name, text, text_len) == 0)
5343 match = 1;
5344
5345 if (match && !encoded)
5346 {
5347 /* One needed check before declaring a positive match is to verify
5348 that iff we are doing a verbatim match, the decoded version
5349 of the symbol name starts with '<'. Otherwise, this symbol name
5350 is not a suitable completion. */
5351 const char *sym_name_copy = sym_name;
5352 int has_angle_bracket;
5353
5354 sym_name = ada_decode (sym_name);
5355 has_angle_bracket = (sym_name[0] == '<');
5356 match = (has_angle_bracket == verbatim_match);
5357 sym_name = sym_name_copy;
5358 }
5359
5360 if (match && !verbatim_match)
5361 {
5362 /* When doing non-verbatim match, another check that needs to
5363 be done is to verify that the potentially matching symbol name
5364 does not include capital letters, because the ada-mode would
5365 not be able to understand these symbol names without the
5366 angle bracket notation. */
5367 const char *tmp;
5368
5369 for (tmp = sym_name; *tmp != '\0' && !isupper (*tmp); tmp++);
5370 if (*tmp != '\0')
5371 match = 0;
5372 }
5373
5374 /* Second: Try wild matching... */
5375
5376 if (!match && wild_match)
5377 {
5378 /* Since we are doing wild matching, this means that TEXT
5379 may represent an unqualified symbol name. We therefore must
5380 also compare TEXT against the unqualified name of the symbol. */
5381 sym_name = ada_unqualified_name (ada_decode (sym_name));
5382
5383 if (strncmp (sym_name, text, text_len) == 0)
5384 match = 1;
5385 }
5386
5387 /* Finally: If we found a mach, prepare the result to return. */
5388
5389 if (!match)
5390 return NULL;
5391
5392 if (verbatim_match)
5393 sym_name = add_angle_brackets (sym_name);
5394
5395 if (!encoded)
5396 sym_name = ada_decode (sym_name);
5397
5398 return sym_name;
5399 }
5400
5401 typedef char *char_ptr;
5402 DEF_VEC_P (char_ptr);
5403
5404 /* A companion function to ada_make_symbol_completion_list().
5405 Check if SYM_NAME represents a symbol which name would be suitable
5406 to complete TEXT (TEXT_LEN is the length of TEXT), in which case
5407 it is appended at the end of the given string vector SV.
5408
5409 ORIG_TEXT is the string original string from the user command
5410 that needs to be completed. WORD is the entire command on which
5411 completion should be performed. These two parameters are used to
5412 determine which part of the symbol name should be added to the
5413 completion vector.
5414 if WILD_MATCH is set, then wild matching is performed.
5415 ENCODED should be set if TEXT represents a symbol name in its
5416 encoded formed (in which case the completion should also be
5417 encoded). */
5418
5419 static void
5420 symbol_completion_add (VEC(char_ptr) **sv,
5421 const char *sym_name,
5422 const char *text, int text_len,
5423 const char *orig_text, const char *word,
5424 int wild_match, int encoded)
5425 {
5426 const char *match = symbol_completion_match (sym_name, text, text_len,
5427 wild_match, encoded);
5428 char *completion;
5429
5430 if (match == NULL)
5431 return;
5432
5433 /* We found a match, so add the appropriate completion to the given
5434 string vector. */
5435
5436 if (word == orig_text)
5437 {
5438 completion = xmalloc (strlen (match) + 5);
5439 strcpy (completion, match);
5440 }
5441 else if (word > orig_text)
5442 {
5443 /* Return some portion of sym_name. */
5444 completion = xmalloc (strlen (match) + 5);
5445 strcpy (completion, match + (word - orig_text));
5446 }
5447 else
5448 {
5449 /* Return some of ORIG_TEXT plus sym_name. */
5450 completion = xmalloc (strlen (match) + (orig_text - word) + 5);
5451 strncpy (completion, word, orig_text - word);
5452 completion[orig_text - word] = '\0';
5453 strcat (completion, match);
5454 }
5455
5456 VEC_safe_push (char_ptr, *sv, completion);
5457 }
5458
5459 /* Return a list of possible symbol names completing TEXT0. The list
5460 is NULL terminated. WORD is the entire command on which completion
5461 is made. */
5462
5463 static char **
5464 ada_make_symbol_completion_list (char *text0, char *word)
5465 {
5466 char *text;
5467 int text_len;
5468 int wild_match;
5469 int encoded;
5470 VEC(char_ptr) *completions = VEC_alloc (char_ptr, 128);
5471 struct symbol *sym;
5472 struct symtab *s;
5473 struct partial_symtab *ps;
5474 struct minimal_symbol *msymbol;
5475 struct objfile *objfile;
5476 struct block *b, *surrounding_static_block = 0;
5477 int i;
5478 struct dict_iterator iter;
5479
5480 if (text0[0] == '<')
5481 {
5482 text = xstrdup (text0);
5483 make_cleanup (xfree, text);
5484 text_len = strlen (text);
5485 wild_match = 0;
5486 encoded = 1;
5487 }
5488 else
5489 {
5490 text = xstrdup (ada_encode (text0));
5491 make_cleanup (xfree, text);
5492 text_len = strlen (text);
5493 for (i = 0; i < text_len; i++)
5494 text[i] = tolower (text[i]);
5495
5496 encoded = (strstr (text0, "__") != NULL);
5497 /* If the name contains a ".", then the user is entering a fully
5498 qualified entity name, and the match must not be done in wild
5499 mode. Similarly, if the user wants to complete what looks like
5500 an encoded name, the match must not be done in wild mode. */
5501 wild_match = (strchr (text0, '.') == NULL && !encoded);
5502 }
5503
5504 /* First, look at the partial symtab symbols. */
5505 ALL_PSYMTABS (objfile, ps)
5506 {
5507 struct partial_symbol **psym;
5508
5509 /* If the psymtab's been read in we'll get it when we search
5510 through the blockvector. */
5511 if (ps->readin)
5512 continue;
5513
5514 for (psym = objfile->global_psymbols.list + ps->globals_offset;
5515 psym < (objfile->global_psymbols.list + ps->globals_offset
5516 + ps->n_global_syms); psym++)
5517 {
5518 QUIT;
5519 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (*psym),
5520 text, text_len, text0, word,
5521 wild_match, encoded);
5522 }
5523
5524 for (psym = objfile->static_psymbols.list + ps->statics_offset;
5525 psym < (objfile->static_psymbols.list + ps->statics_offset
5526 + ps->n_static_syms); psym++)
5527 {
5528 QUIT;
5529 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (*psym),
5530 text, text_len, text0, word,
5531 wild_match, encoded);
5532 }
5533 }
5534
5535 /* At this point scan through the misc symbol vectors and add each
5536 symbol you find to the list. Eventually we want to ignore
5537 anything that isn't a text symbol (everything else will be
5538 handled by the psymtab code above). */
5539
5540 ALL_MSYMBOLS (objfile, msymbol)
5541 {
5542 QUIT;
5543 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (msymbol),
5544 text, text_len, text0, word, wild_match, encoded);
5545 }
5546
5547 /* Search upwards from currently selected frame (so that we can
5548 complete on local vars. */
5549
5550 for (b = get_selected_block (0); b != NULL; b = BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (b))
5551 {
5552 if (!BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (b))
5553 surrounding_static_block = b; /* For elmin of dups */
5554
5555 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
5556 {
5557 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym),
5558 text, text_len, text0, word,
5559 wild_match, encoded);
5560 }
5561 }
5562
5563 /* Go through the symtabs and check the externs and statics for
5564 symbols which match. */
5565
5566 ALL_SYMTABS (objfile, s)
5567 {
5568 QUIT;
5569 b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (BLOCKVECTOR (s), GLOBAL_BLOCK);
5570 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
5571 {
5572 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym),
5573 text, text_len, text0, word,
5574 wild_match, encoded);
5575 }
5576 }
5577
5578 ALL_SYMTABS (objfile, s)
5579 {
5580 QUIT;
5581 b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (BLOCKVECTOR (s), STATIC_BLOCK);
5582 /* Don't do this block twice. */
5583 if (b == surrounding_static_block)
5584 continue;
5585 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
5586 {
5587 symbol_completion_add (&completions, SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym),
5588 text, text_len, text0, word,
5589 wild_match, encoded);
5590 }
5591 }
5592
5593 /* Append the closing NULL entry. */
5594 VEC_safe_push (char_ptr, completions, NULL);
5595
5596 /* Make a copy of the COMPLETIONS VEC before we free it, and then
5597 return the copy. It's unfortunate that we have to make a copy
5598 of an array that we're about to destroy, but there is nothing much
5599 we can do about it. Fortunately, it's typically not a very large
5600 array. */
5601 {
5602 const size_t completions_size =
5603 VEC_length (char_ptr, completions) * sizeof (char *);
5604 char **result = malloc (completions_size);
5605
5606 memcpy (result, VEC_address (char_ptr, completions), completions_size);
5607
5608 VEC_free (char_ptr, completions);
5609 return result;
5610 }
5611 }
5612
5613 /* Field Access */
5614
5615 /* Return non-zero if TYPE is a pointer to the GNAT dispatch table used
5616 for tagged types. */
5617
5618 static int
5619 ada_is_dispatch_table_ptr_type (struct type *type)
5620 {
5621 char *name;
5622
5623 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR)
5624 return 0;
5625
5626 name = TYPE_NAME (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
5627 if (name == NULL)
5628 return 0;
5629
5630 return (strcmp (name, "ada__tags__dispatch_table") == 0);
5631 }
5632
5633 /* True if field number FIELD_NUM in struct or union type TYPE is supposed
5634 to be invisible to users. */
5635
5636 int
5637 ada_is_ignored_field (struct type *type, int field_num)
5638 {
5639 if (field_num < 0 || field_num > TYPE_NFIELDS (type))
5640 return 1;
5641
5642 /* Check the name of that field. */
5643 {
5644 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
5645
5646 /* Anonymous field names should not be printed.
5647 brobecker/2007-02-20: I don't think this can actually happen
5648 but we don't want to print the value of annonymous fields anyway. */
5649 if (name == NULL)
5650 return 1;
5651
5652 /* A field named "_parent" is internally generated by GNAT for
5653 tagged types, and should not be printed either. */
5654 if (name[0] == '_' && strncmp (name, "_parent", 7) != 0)
5655 return 1;
5656 }
5657
5658 /* If this is the dispatch table of a tagged type, then ignore. */
5659 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type, 1)
5660 && ada_is_dispatch_table_ptr_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, field_num)))
5661 return 1;
5662
5663 /* Not a special field, so it should not be ignored. */
5664 return 0;
5665 }
5666
5667 /* True iff TYPE has a tag field. If REFOK, then TYPE may also be a
5668 pointer or reference type whose ultimate target has a tag field. */
5669
5670 int
5671 ada_is_tagged_type (struct type *type, int refok)
5672 {
5673 return (ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "_tag", refok, 1, NULL) != NULL);
5674 }
5675
5676 /* True iff TYPE represents the type of X'Tag */
5677
5678 int
5679 ada_is_tag_type (struct type *type)
5680 {
5681 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR)
5682 return 0;
5683 else
5684 {
5685 const char *name = ada_type_name (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
5686 return (name != NULL
5687 && strcmp (name, "ada__tags__dispatch_table") == 0);
5688 }
5689 }
5690
5691 /* The type of the tag on VAL. */
5692
5693 struct type *
5694 ada_tag_type (struct value *val)
5695 {
5696 return ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (value_type (val), "_tag", 1, 0, NULL);
5697 }
5698
5699 /* The value of the tag on VAL. */
5700
5701 struct value *
5702 ada_value_tag (struct value *val)
5703 {
5704 return ada_value_struct_elt (val, "_tag", 0);
5705 }
5706
5707 /* The value of the tag on the object of type TYPE whose contents are
5708 saved at VALADDR, if it is non-null, or is at memory address
5709 ADDRESS. */
5710
5711 static struct value *
5712 value_tag_from_contents_and_address (struct type *type,
5713 const gdb_byte *valaddr,
5714 CORE_ADDR address)
5715 {
5716 int tag_byte_offset, dummy1, dummy2;
5717 struct type *tag_type;
5718 if (find_struct_field ("_tag", type, 0, &tag_type, &tag_byte_offset,
5719 NULL, NULL, NULL))
5720 {
5721 const gdb_byte *valaddr1 = ((valaddr == NULL)
5722 ? NULL
5723 : valaddr + tag_byte_offset);
5724 CORE_ADDR address1 = (address == 0) ? 0 : address + tag_byte_offset;
5725
5726 return value_from_contents_and_address (tag_type, valaddr1, address1);
5727 }
5728 return NULL;
5729 }
5730
5731 static struct type *
5732 type_from_tag (struct value *tag)
5733 {
5734 const char *type_name = ada_tag_name (tag);
5735 if (type_name != NULL)
5736 return ada_find_any_type (ada_encode (type_name));
5737 return NULL;
5738 }
5739
5740 struct tag_args
5741 {
5742 struct value *tag;
5743 char *name;
5744 };
5745
5746
5747 static int ada_tag_name_1 (void *);
5748 static int ada_tag_name_2 (struct tag_args *);
5749
5750 /* Wrapper function used by ada_tag_name. Given a struct tag_args*
5751 value ARGS, sets ARGS->name to the tag name of ARGS->tag.
5752 The value stored in ARGS->name is valid until the next call to
5753 ada_tag_name_1. */
5754
5755 static int
5756 ada_tag_name_1 (void *args0)
5757 {
5758 struct tag_args *args = (struct tag_args *) args0;
5759 static char name[1024];
5760 char *p;
5761 struct value *val;
5762 args->name = NULL;
5763 val = ada_value_struct_elt (args->tag, "tsd", 1);
5764 if (val == NULL)
5765 return ada_tag_name_2 (args);
5766 val = ada_value_struct_elt (val, "expanded_name", 1);
5767 if (val == NULL)
5768 return 0;
5769 read_memory_string (value_as_address (val), name, sizeof (name) - 1);
5770 for (p = name; *p != '\0'; p += 1)
5771 if (isalpha (*p))
5772 *p = tolower (*p);
5773 args->name = name;
5774 return 0;
5775 }
5776
5777 /* Utility function for ada_tag_name_1 that tries the second
5778 representation for the dispatch table (in which there is no
5779 explicit 'tsd' field in the referent of the tag pointer, and instead
5780 the tsd pointer is stored just before the dispatch table. */
5781
5782 static int
5783 ada_tag_name_2 (struct tag_args *args)
5784 {
5785 struct type *info_type;
5786 static char name[1024];
5787 char *p;
5788 struct value *val, *valp;
5789
5790 args->name = NULL;
5791 info_type = ada_find_any_type ("ada__tags__type_specific_data");
5792 if (info_type == NULL)
5793 return 0;
5794 info_type = lookup_pointer_type (lookup_pointer_type (info_type));
5795 valp = value_cast (info_type, args->tag);
5796 if (valp == NULL)
5797 return 0;
5798 val = value_ind (value_add (valp, value_from_longest (builtin_type_int, -1)));
5799 if (val == NULL)
5800 return 0;
5801 val = ada_value_struct_elt (val, "expanded_name", 1);
5802 if (val == NULL)
5803 return 0;
5804 read_memory_string (value_as_address (val), name, sizeof (name) - 1);
5805 for (p = name; *p != '\0'; p += 1)
5806 if (isalpha (*p))
5807 *p = tolower (*p);
5808 args->name = name;
5809 return 0;
5810 }
5811
5812 /* The type name of the dynamic type denoted by the 'tag value TAG, as
5813 * a C string. */
5814
5815 const char *
5816 ada_tag_name (struct value *tag)
5817 {
5818 struct tag_args args;
5819 if (!ada_is_tag_type (value_type (tag)))
5820 return NULL;
5821 args.tag = tag;
5822 args.name = NULL;
5823 catch_errors (ada_tag_name_1, &args, NULL, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
5824 return args.name;
5825 }
5826
5827 /* The parent type of TYPE, or NULL if none. */
5828
5829 struct type *
5830 ada_parent_type (struct type *type)
5831 {
5832 int i;
5833
5834 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
5835
5836 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
5837 return NULL;
5838
5839 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
5840 if (ada_is_parent_field (type, i))
5841 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
5842
5843 return NULL;
5844 }
5845
5846 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure type TYPE contains the
5847 parent-type (inherited) fields of a derived type. Assumes TYPE is
5848 a structure type with at least FIELD_NUM+1 fields. */
5849
5850 int
5851 ada_is_parent_field (struct type *type, int field_num)
5852 {
5853 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (ada_check_typedef (type), field_num);
5854 return (name != NULL
5855 && (strncmp (name, "PARENT", 6) == 0
5856 || strncmp (name, "_parent", 7) == 0));
5857 }
5858
5859 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure type TYPE is a
5860 transparent wrapper field (which should be silently traversed when doing
5861 field selection and flattened when printing). Assumes TYPE is a
5862 structure type with at least FIELD_NUM+1 fields. Such fields are always
5863 structures. */
5864
5865 int
5866 ada_is_wrapper_field (struct type *type, int field_num)
5867 {
5868 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
5869 return (name != NULL
5870 && (strncmp (name, "PARENT", 6) == 0
5871 || strcmp (name, "REP") == 0
5872 || strncmp (name, "_parent", 7) == 0
5873 || name[0] == 'S' || name[0] == 'R' || name[0] == 'O'));
5874 }
5875
5876 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure or union type TYPE
5877 is a variant wrapper. Assumes TYPE is a structure type with at least
5878 FIELD_NUM+1 fields. */
5879
5880 int
5881 ada_is_variant_part (struct type *type, int field_num)
5882 {
5883 struct type *field_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, field_num);
5884 return (TYPE_CODE (field_type) == TYPE_CODE_UNION
5885 || (is_dynamic_field (type, field_num)
5886 && (TYPE_CODE (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (field_type))
5887 == TYPE_CODE_UNION)));
5888 }
5889
5890 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is a variant wrapper (type of the variant part)
5891 whose discriminants are contained in the record type OUTER_TYPE,
5892 returns the type of the controlling discriminant for the variant. */
5893
5894 struct type *
5895 ada_variant_discrim_type (struct type *var_type, struct type *outer_type)
5896 {
5897 char *name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type);
5898 struct type *type =
5899 ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (outer_type, name, 1, 1, NULL);
5900 if (type == NULL)
5901 return builtin_type_int;
5902 else
5903 return type;
5904 }
5905
5906 /* Assuming that TYPE is the type of a variant wrapper, and FIELD_NUM is a
5907 valid field number within it, returns 1 iff field FIELD_NUM of TYPE
5908 represents a 'when others' clause; otherwise 0. */
5909
5910 int
5911 ada_is_others_clause (struct type *type, int field_num)
5912 {
5913 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
5914 return (name != NULL && name[0] == 'O');
5915 }
5916
5917 /* Assuming that TYPE0 is the type of the variant part of a record,
5918 returns the name of the discriminant controlling the variant.
5919 The value is valid until the next call to ada_variant_discrim_name. */
5920
5921 char *
5922 ada_variant_discrim_name (struct type *type0)
5923 {
5924 static char *result = NULL;
5925 static size_t result_len = 0;
5926 struct type *type;
5927 const char *name;
5928 const char *discrim_end;
5929 const char *discrim_start;
5930
5931 if (TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
5932 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0);
5933 else
5934 type = type0;
5935
5936 name = ada_type_name (type);
5937
5938 if (name == NULL || name[0] == '\000')
5939 return "";
5940
5941 for (discrim_end = name + strlen (name) - 6; discrim_end != name;
5942 discrim_end -= 1)
5943 {
5944 if (strncmp (discrim_end, "___XVN", 6) == 0)
5945 break;
5946 }
5947 if (discrim_end == name)
5948 return "";
5949
5950 for (discrim_start = discrim_end; discrim_start != name + 3;
5951 discrim_start -= 1)
5952 {
5953 if (discrim_start == name + 1)
5954 return "";
5955 if ((discrim_start > name + 3
5956 && strncmp (discrim_start - 3, "___", 3) == 0)
5957 || discrim_start[-1] == '.')
5958 break;
5959 }
5960
5961 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, discrim_end - discrim_start + 1);
5962 strncpy (result, discrim_start, discrim_end - discrim_start);
5963 result[discrim_end - discrim_start] = '\0';
5964 return result;
5965 }
5966
5967 /* Scan STR for a subtype-encoded number, beginning at position K.
5968 Put the position of the character just past the number scanned in
5969 *NEW_K, if NEW_K!=NULL. Put the scanned number in *R, if R!=NULL.
5970 Return 1 if there was a valid number at the given position, and 0
5971 otherwise. A "subtype-encoded" number consists of the absolute value
5972 in decimal, followed by the letter 'm' to indicate a negative number.
5973 Assumes 0m does not occur. */
5974
5975 int
5976 ada_scan_number (const char str[], int k, LONGEST * R, int *new_k)
5977 {
5978 ULONGEST RU;
5979
5980 if (!isdigit (str[k]))
5981 return 0;
5982
5983 /* Do it the hard way so as not to make any assumption about
5984 the relationship of unsigned long (%lu scan format code) and
5985 LONGEST. */
5986 RU = 0;
5987 while (isdigit (str[k]))
5988 {
5989 RU = RU * 10 + (str[k] - '0');
5990 k += 1;
5991 }
5992
5993 if (str[k] == 'm')
5994 {
5995 if (R != NULL)
5996 *R = (-(LONGEST) (RU - 1)) - 1;
5997 k += 1;
5998 }
5999 else if (R != NULL)
6000 *R = (LONGEST) RU;
6001
6002 /* NOTE on the above: Technically, C does not say what the results of
6003 - (LONGEST) RU or (LONGEST) -RU are for RU == largest positive
6004 number representable as a LONGEST (although either would probably work
6005 in most implementations). When RU>0, the locution in the then branch
6006 above is always equivalent to the negative of RU. */
6007
6008 if (new_k != NULL)
6009 *new_k = k;
6010 return 1;
6011 }
6012
6013 /* Assuming that TYPE is a variant part wrapper type (a VARIANTS field),
6014 and FIELD_NUM is a valid field number within it, returns 1 iff VAL is
6015 in the range encoded by field FIELD_NUM of TYPE; otherwise 0. */
6016
6017 int
6018 ada_in_variant (LONGEST val, struct type *type, int field_num)
6019 {
6020 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
6021 int p;
6022
6023 p = 0;
6024 while (1)
6025 {
6026 switch (name[p])
6027 {
6028 case '\0':
6029 return 0;
6030 case 'S':
6031 {
6032 LONGEST W;
6033 if (!ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &W, &p))
6034 return 0;
6035 if (val == W)
6036 return 1;
6037 break;
6038 }
6039 case 'R':
6040 {
6041 LONGEST L, U;
6042 if (!ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &L, &p)
6043 || name[p] != 'T' || !ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &U, &p))
6044 return 0;
6045 if (val >= L && val <= U)
6046 return 1;
6047 break;
6048 }
6049 case 'O':
6050 return 1;
6051 default:
6052 return 0;
6053 }
6054 }
6055 }
6056
6057 /* FIXME: Lots of redundancy below. Try to consolidate. */
6058
6059 /* Given a value ARG1 (offset by OFFSET bytes) of a struct or union type
6060 ARG_TYPE, extract and return the value of one of its (non-static)
6061 fields. FIELDNO says which field. Differs from value_primitive_field
6062 only in that it can handle packed values of arbitrary type. */
6063
6064 static struct value *
6065 ada_value_primitive_field (struct value *arg1, int offset, int fieldno,
6066 struct type *arg_type)
6067 {
6068 struct type *type;
6069
6070 arg_type = ada_check_typedef (arg_type);
6071 type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (arg_type, fieldno);
6072
6073 /* Handle packed fields. */
6074
6075 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (arg_type, fieldno) != 0)
6076 {
6077 int bit_pos = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (arg_type, fieldno);
6078 int bit_size = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (arg_type, fieldno);
6079
6080 return ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arg1, value_contents (arg1),
6081 offset + bit_pos / 8,
6082 bit_pos % 8, bit_size, type);
6083 }
6084 else
6085 return value_primitive_field (arg1, offset, fieldno, arg_type);
6086 }
6087
6088 /* Find field with name NAME in object of type TYPE. If found,
6089 set the following for each argument that is non-null:
6090 - *FIELD_TYPE_P to the field's type;
6091 - *BYTE_OFFSET_P to OFFSET + the byte offset of the field within
6092 an object of that type;
6093 - *BIT_OFFSET_P to the bit offset modulo byte size of the field;
6094 - *BIT_SIZE_P to its size in bits if the field is packed, and
6095 0 otherwise;
6096 If INDEX_P is non-null, increment *INDEX_P by the number of source-visible
6097 fields up to but not including the desired field, or by the total
6098 number of fields if not found. A NULL value of NAME never
6099 matches; the function just counts visible fields in this case.
6100
6101 Returns 1 if found, 0 otherwise. */
6102
6103 static int
6104 find_struct_field (char *name, struct type *type, int offset,
6105 struct type **field_type_p,
6106 int *byte_offset_p, int *bit_offset_p, int *bit_size_p,
6107 int *index_p)
6108 {
6109 int i;
6110
6111 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6112
6113 if (field_type_p != NULL)
6114 *field_type_p = NULL;
6115 if (byte_offset_p != NULL)
6116 *byte_offset_p = 0;
6117 if (bit_offset_p != NULL)
6118 *bit_offset_p = 0;
6119 if (bit_size_p != NULL)
6120 *bit_size_p = 0;
6121
6122 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
6123 {
6124 int bit_pos = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i);
6125 int fld_offset = offset + bit_pos / 8;
6126 char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i);
6127
6128 if (t_field_name == NULL)
6129 continue;
6130
6131 else if (name != NULL && field_name_match (t_field_name, name))
6132 {
6133 int bit_size = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, i);
6134 if (field_type_p != NULL)
6135 *field_type_p = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i);
6136 if (byte_offset_p != NULL)
6137 *byte_offset_p = fld_offset;
6138 if (bit_offset_p != NULL)
6139 *bit_offset_p = bit_pos % 8;
6140 if (bit_size_p != NULL)
6141 *bit_size_p = bit_size;
6142 return 1;
6143 }
6144 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
6145 {
6146 if (find_struct_field (name, TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i), fld_offset,
6147 field_type_p, byte_offset_p, bit_offset_p,
6148 bit_size_p, index_p))
6149 return 1;
6150 }
6151 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
6152 {
6153 /* PNH: Wait. Do we ever execute this section, or is ARG always of
6154 fixed type?? */
6155 int j;
6156 struct type *field_type
6157 = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
6158
6159 for (j = 0; j < TYPE_NFIELDS (field_type); j += 1)
6160 {
6161 if (find_struct_field (name, TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j),
6162 fld_offset
6163 + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, j) / 8,
6164 field_type_p, byte_offset_p,
6165 bit_offset_p, bit_size_p, index_p))
6166 return 1;
6167 }
6168 }
6169 else if (index_p != NULL)
6170 *index_p += 1;
6171 }
6172 return 0;
6173 }
6174
6175 /* Number of user-visible fields in record type TYPE. */
6176
6177 static int
6178 num_visible_fields (struct type *type)
6179 {
6180 int n;
6181 n = 0;
6182 find_struct_field (NULL, type, 0, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, &n);
6183 return n;
6184 }
6185
6186 /* Look for a field NAME in ARG. Adjust the address of ARG by OFFSET bytes,
6187 and search in it assuming it has (class) type TYPE.
6188 If found, return value, else return NULL.
6189
6190 Searches recursively through wrapper fields (e.g., '_parent'). */
6191
6192 static struct value *
6193 ada_search_struct_field (char *name, struct value *arg, int offset,
6194 struct type *type)
6195 {
6196 int i;
6197 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6198
6199 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
6200 {
6201 char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i);
6202
6203 if (t_field_name == NULL)
6204 continue;
6205
6206 else if (field_name_match (t_field_name, name))
6207 return ada_value_primitive_field (arg, offset, i, type);
6208
6209 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
6210 {
6211 struct value *v = /* Do not let indent join lines here. */
6212 ada_search_struct_field (name, arg,
6213 offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8,
6214 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
6215 if (v != NULL)
6216 return v;
6217 }
6218
6219 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
6220 {
6221 /* PNH: Do we ever get here? See find_struct_field. */
6222 int j;
6223 struct type *field_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
6224 int var_offset = offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
6225
6226 for (j = 0; j < TYPE_NFIELDS (field_type); j += 1)
6227 {
6228 struct value *v = ada_search_struct_field /* Force line break. */
6229 (name, arg,
6230 var_offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, j) / 8,
6231 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j));
6232 if (v != NULL)
6233 return v;
6234 }
6235 }
6236 }
6237 return NULL;
6238 }
6239
6240 static struct value *ada_index_struct_field_1 (int *, struct value *,
6241 int, struct type *);
6242
6243
6244 /* Return field #INDEX in ARG, where the index is that returned by
6245 * find_struct_field through its INDEX_P argument. Adjust the address
6246 * of ARG by OFFSET bytes, and search in it assuming it has (class) type TYPE.
6247 * If found, return value, else return NULL. */
6248
6249 static struct value *
6250 ada_index_struct_field (int index, struct value *arg, int offset,
6251 struct type *type)
6252 {
6253 return ada_index_struct_field_1 (&index, arg, offset, type);
6254 }
6255
6256
6257 /* Auxiliary function for ada_index_struct_field. Like
6258 * ada_index_struct_field, but takes index from *INDEX_P and modifies
6259 * *INDEX_P. */
6260
6261 static struct value *
6262 ada_index_struct_field_1 (int *index_p, struct value *arg, int offset,
6263 struct type *type)
6264 {
6265 int i;
6266 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6267
6268 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
6269 {
6270 if (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i) == NULL)
6271 continue;
6272 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
6273 {
6274 struct value *v = /* Do not let indent join lines here. */
6275 ada_index_struct_field_1 (index_p, arg,
6276 offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8,
6277 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
6278 if (v != NULL)
6279 return v;
6280 }
6281
6282 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
6283 {
6284 /* PNH: Do we ever get here? See ada_search_struct_field,
6285 find_struct_field. */
6286 error (_("Cannot assign this kind of variant record"));
6287 }
6288 else if (*index_p == 0)
6289 return ada_value_primitive_field (arg, offset, i, type);
6290 else
6291 *index_p -= 1;
6292 }
6293 return NULL;
6294 }
6295
6296 /* Given ARG, a value of type (pointer or reference to a)*
6297 structure/union, extract the component named NAME from the ultimate
6298 target structure/union and return it as a value with its
6299 appropriate type. If ARG is a pointer or reference and the field
6300 is not packed, returns a reference to the field, otherwise the
6301 value of the field (an lvalue if ARG is an lvalue).
6302
6303 The routine searches for NAME among all members of the structure itself
6304 and (recursively) among all members of any wrapper members
6305 (e.g., '_parent').
6306
6307 If NO_ERR, then simply return NULL in case of error, rather than
6308 calling error. */
6309
6310 struct value *
6311 ada_value_struct_elt (struct value *arg, char *name, int no_err)
6312 {
6313 struct type *t, *t1;
6314 struct value *v;
6315
6316 v = NULL;
6317 t1 = t = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg));
6318 if (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
6319 {
6320 t1 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (t);
6321 if (t1 == NULL)
6322 goto BadValue;
6323 t1 = ada_check_typedef (t1);
6324 if (TYPE_CODE (t1) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6325 {
6326 arg = coerce_ref (arg);
6327 t = t1;
6328 }
6329 }
6330
6331 while (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6332 {
6333 t1 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (t);
6334 if (t1 == NULL)
6335 goto BadValue;
6336 t1 = ada_check_typedef (t1);
6337 if (TYPE_CODE (t1) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6338 {
6339 arg = value_ind (arg);
6340 t = t1;
6341 }
6342 else
6343 break;
6344 }
6345
6346 if (TYPE_CODE (t1) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT && TYPE_CODE (t1) != TYPE_CODE_UNION)
6347 goto BadValue;
6348
6349 if (t1 == t)
6350 v = ada_search_struct_field (name, arg, 0, t);
6351 else
6352 {
6353 int bit_offset, bit_size, byte_offset;
6354 struct type *field_type;
6355 CORE_ADDR address;
6356
6357 if (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6358 address = value_as_address (arg);
6359 else
6360 address = unpack_pointer (t, value_contents (arg));
6361
6362 t1 = ada_to_fixed_type (ada_get_base_type (t1), NULL, address, NULL, 1);
6363 if (find_struct_field (name, t1, 0,
6364 &field_type, &byte_offset, &bit_offset,
6365 &bit_size, NULL))
6366 {
6367 if (bit_size != 0)
6368 {
6369 if (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
6370 arg = ada_coerce_ref (arg);
6371 else
6372 arg = ada_value_ind (arg);
6373 v = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arg, NULL, byte_offset,
6374 bit_offset, bit_size,
6375 field_type);
6376 }
6377 else
6378 v = value_from_pointer (lookup_reference_type (field_type),
6379 address + byte_offset);
6380 }
6381 }
6382
6383 if (v != NULL || no_err)
6384 return v;
6385 else
6386 error (_("There is no member named %s."), name);
6387
6388 BadValue:
6389 if (no_err)
6390 return NULL;
6391 else
6392 error (_("Attempt to extract a component of a value that is not a record."));
6393 }
6394
6395 /* Given a type TYPE, look up the type of the component of type named NAME.
6396 If DISPP is non-null, add its byte displacement from the beginning of a
6397 structure (pointed to by a value) of type TYPE to *DISPP (does not
6398 work for packed fields).
6399
6400 Matches any field whose name has NAME as a prefix, possibly
6401 followed by "___".
6402
6403 TYPE can be either a struct or union. If REFOK, TYPE may also
6404 be a (pointer or reference)+ to a struct or union, and the
6405 ultimate target type will be searched.
6406
6407 Looks recursively into variant clauses and parent types.
6408
6409 If NOERR is nonzero, return NULL if NAME is not suitably defined or
6410 TYPE is not a type of the right kind. */
6411
6412 static struct type *
6413 ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (struct type *type, char *name, int refok,
6414 int noerr, int *dispp)
6415 {
6416 int i;
6417
6418 if (name == NULL)
6419 goto BadName;
6420
6421 if (refok && type != NULL)
6422 while (1)
6423 {
6424 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6425 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR
6426 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_REF)
6427 break;
6428 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
6429 }
6430
6431 if (type == NULL
6432 || (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
6433 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_UNION))
6434 {
6435 if (noerr)
6436 return NULL;
6437 else
6438 {
6439 target_terminal_ours ();
6440 gdb_flush (gdb_stdout);
6441 if (type == NULL)
6442 error (_("Type (null) is not a structure or union type"));
6443 else
6444 {
6445 /* XXX: type_sprint */
6446 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stderr, _("Type "));
6447 type_print (type, "", gdb_stderr, -1);
6448 error (_(" is not a structure or union type"));
6449 }
6450 }
6451 }
6452
6453 type = to_static_fixed_type (type);
6454
6455 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
6456 {
6457 char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i);
6458 struct type *t;
6459 int disp;
6460
6461 if (t_field_name == NULL)
6462 continue;
6463
6464 else if (field_name_match (t_field_name, name))
6465 {
6466 if (dispp != NULL)
6467 *dispp += TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
6468 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
6469 }
6470
6471 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
6472 {
6473 disp = 0;
6474 t = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i), name,
6475 0, 1, &disp);
6476 if (t != NULL)
6477 {
6478 if (dispp != NULL)
6479 *dispp += disp + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
6480 return t;
6481 }
6482 }
6483
6484 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
6485 {
6486 int j;
6487 struct type *field_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
6488
6489 for (j = TYPE_NFIELDS (field_type) - 1; j >= 0; j -= 1)
6490 {
6491 disp = 0;
6492 t = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j),
6493 name, 0, 1, &disp);
6494 if (t != NULL)
6495 {
6496 if (dispp != NULL)
6497 *dispp += disp + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
6498 return t;
6499 }
6500 }
6501 }
6502
6503 }
6504
6505 BadName:
6506 if (!noerr)
6507 {
6508 target_terminal_ours ();
6509 gdb_flush (gdb_stdout);
6510 if (name == NULL)
6511 {
6512 /* XXX: type_sprint */
6513 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stderr, _("Type "));
6514 type_print (type, "", gdb_stderr, -1);
6515 error (_(" has no component named <null>"));
6516 }
6517 else
6518 {
6519 /* XXX: type_sprint */
6520 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stderr, _("Type "));
6521 type_print (type, "", gdb_stderr, -1);
6522 error (_(" has no component named %s"), name);
6523 }
6524 }
6525
6526 return NULL;
6527 }
6528
6529 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is the type of a variant part of a record (a union),
6530 within a value of type OUTER_TYPE that is stored in GDB at
6531 OUTER_VALADDR, determine which variant clause (field number in VAR_TYPE,
6532 numbering from 0) is applicable. Returns -1 if none are. */
6533
6534 int
6535 ada_which_variant_applies (struct type *var_type, struct type *outer_type,
6536 const gdb_byte *outer_valaddr)
6537 {
6538 int others_clause;
6539 int i;
6540 char *discrim_name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type);
6541 struct value *outer;
6542 struct value *discrim;
6543 LONGEST discrim_val;
6544
6545 outer = value_from_contents_and_address (outer_type, outer_valaddr, 0);
6546 discrim = ada_value_struct_elt (outer, discrim_name, 1);
6547 if (discrim == NULL)
6548 return -1;
6549 discrim_val = value_as_long (discrim);
6550
6551 others_clause = -1;
6552 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (var_type); i += 1)
6553 {
6554 if (ada_is_others_clause (var_type, i))
6555 others_clause = i;
6556 else if (ada_in_variant (discrim_val, var_type, i))
6557 return i;
6558 }
6559
6560 return others_clause;
6561 }
6562 \f
6563
6564
6565 /* Dynamic-Sized Records */
6566
6567 /* Strategy: The type ostensibly attached to a value with dynamic size
6568 (i.e., a size that is not statically recorded in the debugging
6569 data) does not accurately reflect the size or layout of the value.
6570 Our strategy is to convert these values to values with accurate,
6571 conventional types that are constructed on the fly. */
6572
6573 /* There is a subtle and tricky problem here. In general, we cannot
6574 determine the size of dynamic records without its data. However,
6575 the 'struct value' data structure, which GDB uses to represent
6576 quantities in the inferior process (the target), requires the size
6577 of the type at the time of its allocation in order to reserve space
6578 for GDB's internal copy of the data. That's why the
6579 'to_fixed_xxx_type' routines take (target) addresses as parameters,
6580 rather than struct value*s.
6581
6582 However, GDB's internal history variables ($1, $2, etc.) are
6583 struct value*s containing internal copies of the data that are not, in
6584 general, the same as the data at their corresponding addresses in
6585 the target. Fortunately, the types we give to these values are all
6586 conventional, fixed-size types (as per the strategy described
6587 above), so that we don't usually have to perform the
6588 'to_fixed_xxx_type' conversions to look at their values.
6589 Unfortunately, there is one exception: if one of the internal
6590 history variables is an array whose elements are unconstrained
6591 records, then we will need to create distinct fixed types for each
6592 element selected. */
6593
6594 /* The upshot of all of this is that many routines take a (type, host
6595 address, target address) triple as arguments to represent a value.
6596 The host address, if non-null, is supposed to contain an internal
6597 copy of the relevant data; otherwise, the program is to consult the
6598 target at the target address. */
6599
6600 /* Assuming that VAL0 represents a pointer value, the result of
6601 dereferencing it. Differs from value_ind in its treatment of
6602 dynamic-sized types. */
6603
6604 struct value *
6605 ada_value_ind (struct value *val0)
6606 {
6607 struct value *val = unwrap_value (value_ind (val0));
6608 return ada_to_fixed_value (val);
6609 }
6610
6611 /* The value resulting from dereferencing any "reference to"
6612 qualifiers on VAL0. */
6613
6614 static struct value *
6615 ada_coerce_ref (struct value *val0)
6616 {
6617 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (val0)) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
6618 {
6619 struct value *val = val0;
6620 val = coerce_ref (val);
6621 val = unwrap_value (val);
6622 return ada_to_fixed_value (val);
6623 }
6624 else
6625 return val0;
6626 }
6627
6628 /* Return OFF rounded upward if necessary to a multiple of
6629 ALIGNMENT (a power of 2). */
6630
6631 static unsigned int
6632 align_value (unsigned int off, unsigned int alignment)
6633 {
6634 return (off + alignment - 1) & ~(alignment - 1);
6635 }
6636
6637 /* Return the bit alignment required for field #F of template type TYPE. */
6638
6639 static unsigned int
6640 field_alignment (struct type *type, int f)
6641 {
6642 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f);
6643 int len;
6644 int align_offset;
6645
6646 /* The field name should never be null, unless the debugging information
6647 is somehow malformed. In this case, we assume the field does not
6648 require any alignment. */
6649 if (name == NULL)
6650 return 1;
6651
6652 len = strlen (name);
6653
6654 if (!isdigit (name[len - 1]))
6655 return 1;
6656
6657 if (isdigit (name[len - 2]))
6658 align_offset = len - 2;
6659 else
6660 align_offset = len - 1;
6661
6662 if (align_offset < 7 || strncmp ("___XV", name + align_offset - 6, 5) != 0)
6663 return TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
6664
6665 return atoi (name + align_offset) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
6666 }
6667
6668 /* Find a symbol named NAME. Ignores ambiguity. */
6669
6670 struct symbol *
6671 ada_find_any_symbol (const char *name)
6672 {
6673 struct symbol *sym;
6674
6675 sym = standard_lookup (name, get_selected_block (NULL), VAR_DOMAIN);
6676 if (sym != NULL && SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_TYPEDEF)
6677 return sym;
6678
6679 sym = standard_lookup (name, NULL, STRUCT_DOMAIN);
6680 return sym;
6681 }
6682
6683 /* Find a type named NAME. Ignores ambiguity. */
6684
6685 struct type *
6686 ada_find_any_type (const char *name)
6687 {
6688 struct symbol *sym = ada_find_any_symbol (name);
6689
6690 if (sym != NULL)
6691 return SYMBOL_TYPE (sym);
6692
6693 return NULL;
6694 }
6695
6696 /* Given NAME and an associated BLOCK, search all symbols for
6697 NAME suffixed with "___XR", which is the ``renaming'' symbol
6698 associated to NAME. Return this symbol if found, return
6699 NULL otherwise. */
6700
6701 struct symbol *
6702 ada_find_renaming_symbol (const char *name, struct block *block)
6703 {
6704 struct symbol *sym;
6705
6706 sym = find_old_style_renaming_symbol (name, block);
6707
6708 if (sym != NULL)
6709 return sym;
6710
6711 /* Not right yet. FIXME pnh 7/20/2007. */
6712 sym = ada_find_any_symbol (name);
6713 if (sym != NULL && strstr (SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (sym), "___XR") != NULL)
6714 return sym;
6715 else
6716 return NULL;
6717 }
6718
6719 static struct symbol *
6720 find_old_style_renaming_symbol (const char *name, struct block *block)
6721 {
6722 const struct symbol *function_sym = block_function (block);
6723 char *rename;
6724
6725 if (function_sym != NULL)
6726 {
6727 /* If the symbol is defined inside a function, NAME is not fully
6728 qualified. This means we need to prepend the function name
6729 as well as adding the ``___XR'' suffix to build the name of
6730 the associated renaming symbol. */
6731 char *function_name = SYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (function_sym);
6732 /* Function names sometimes contain suffixes used
6733 for instance to qualify nested subprograms. When building
6734 the XR type name, we need to make sure that this suffix is
6735 not included. So do not include any suffix in the function
6736 name length below. */
6737 const int function_name_len = ada_name_prefix_len (function_name);
6738 const int rename_len = function_name_len + 2 /* "__" */
6739 + strlen (name) + 6 /* "___XR\0" */ ;
6740
6741 /* Strip the suffix if necessary. */
6742 function_name[function_name_len] = '\0';
6743
6744 /* Library-level functions are a special case, as GNAT adds
6745 a ``_ada_'' prefix to the function name to avoid namespace
6746 pollution. However, the renaming symbols themselves do not
6747 have this prefix, so we need to skip this prefix if present. */
6748 if (function_name_len > 5 /* "_ada_" */
6749 && strstr (function_name, "_ada_") == function_name)
6750 function_name = function_name + 5;
6751
6752 rename = (char *) alloca (rename_len * sizeof (char));
6753 sprintf (rename, "%s__%s___XR", function_name, name);
6754 }
6755 else
6756 {
6757 const int rename_len = strlen (name) + 6;
6758 rename = (char *) alloca (rename_len * sizeof (char));
6759 sprintf (rename, "%s___XR", name);
6760 }
6761
6762 return ada_find_any_symbol (rename);
6763 }
6764
6765 /* Because of GNAT encoding conventions, several GDB symbols may match a
6766 given type name. If the type denoted by TYPE0 is to be preferred to
6767 that of TYPE1 for purposes of type printing, return non-zero;
6768 otherwise return 0. */
6769
6770 int
6771 ada_prefer_type (struct type *type0, struct type *type1)
6772 {
6773 if (type1 == NULL)
6774 return 1;
6775 else if (type0 == NULL)
6776 return 0;
6777 else if (TYPE_CODE (type1) == TYPE_CODE_VOID)
6778 return 1;
6779 else if (TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_VOID)
6780 return 0;
6781 else if (TYPE_NAME (type1) == NULL && TYPE_NAME (type0) != NULL)
6782 return 1;
6783 else if (ada_is_packed_array_type (type0))
6784 return 1;
6785 else if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type0)
6786 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type1))
6787 return 1;
6788 else
6789 {
6790 const char *type0_name = type_name_no_tag (type0);
6791 const char *type1_name = type_name_no_tag (type1);
6792
6793 if (type0_name != NULL && strstr (type0_name, "___XR") != NULL
6794 && (type1_name == NULL || strstr (type1_name, "___XR") == NULL))
6795 return 1;
6796 }
6797 return 0;
6798 }
6799
6800 /* The name of TYPE, which is either its TYPE_NAME, or, if that is
6801 null, its TYPE_TAG_NAME. Null if TYPE is null. */
6802
6803 char *
6804 ada_type_name (struct type *type)
6805 {
6806 if (type == NULL)
6807 return NULL;
6808 else if (TYPE_NAME (type) != NULL)
6809 return TYPE_NAME (type);
6810 else
6811 return TYPE_TAG_NAME (type);
6812 }
6813
6814 /* Find a parallel type to TYPE whose name is formed by appending
6815 SUFFIX to the name of TYPE. */
6816
6817 struct type *
6818 ada_find_parallel_type (struct type *type, const char *suffix)
6819 {
6820 static char *name;
6821 static size_t name_len = 0;
6822 int len;
6823 char *typename = ada_type_name (type);
6824
6825 if (typename == NULL)
6826 return NULL;
6827
6828 len = strlen (typename);
6829
6830 GROW_VECT (name, name_len, len + strlen (suffix) + 1);
6831
6832 strcpy (name, typename);
6833 strcpy (name + len, suffix);
6834
6835 return ada_find_any_type (name);
6836 }
6837
6838
6839 /* If TYPE is a variable-size record type, return the corresponding template
6840 type describing its fields. Otherwise, return NULL. */
6841
6842 static struct type *
6843 dynamic_template_type (struct type *type)
6844 {
6845 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6846
6847 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
6848 || ada_type_name (type) == NULL)
6849 return NULL;
6850 else
6851 {
6852 int len = strlen (ada_type_name (type));
6853 if (len > 6 && strcmp (ada_type_name (type) + len - 6, "___XVE") == 0)
6854 return type;
6855 else
6856 return ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVE");
6857 }
6858 }
6859
6860 /* Assuming that TEMPL_TYPE is a union or struct type, returns
6861 non-zero iff field FIELD_NUM of TEMPL_TYPE has dynamic size. */
6862
6863 static int
6864 is_dynamic_field (struct type *templ_type, int field_num)
6865 {
6866 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (templ_type, field_num);
6867 return name != NULL
6868 && TYPE_CODE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (templ_type, field_num)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
6869 && strstr (name, "___XVL") != NULL;
6870 }
6871
6872 /* The index of the variant field of TYPE, or -1 if TYPE does not
6873 represent a variant record type. */
6874
6875 static int
6876 variant_field_index (struct type *type)
6877 {
6878 int f;
6879
6880 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
6881 return -1;
6882
6883 for (f = 0; f < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); f += 1)
6884 {
6885 if (ada_is_variant_part (type, f))
6886 return f;
6887 }
6888 return -1;
6889 }
6890
6891 /* A record type with no fields. */
6892
6893 static struct type *
6894 empty_record (struct objfile *objfile)
6895 {
6896 struct type *type = alloc_type (objfile);
6897 TYPE_CODE (type) = TYPE_CODE_STRUCT;
6898 TYPE_NFIELDS (type) = 0;
6899 TYPE_FIELDS (type) = NULL;
6900 TYPE_NAME (type) = "<empty>";
6901 TYPE_TAG_NAME (type) = NULL;
6902 TYPE_FLAGS (type) = 0;
6903 TYPE_LENGTH (type) = 0;
6904 return type;
6905 }
6906
6907 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes
6908 the value of type TYPE at VALADDR or ADDRESS (see comments at
6909 the beginning of this section) VAL according to GNAT conventions.
6910 DVAL0 should describe the (portion of a) record that contains any
6911 necessary discriminants. It should be NULL if value_type (VAL) is
6912 an outer-level type (i.e., as opposed to a branch of a variant.) A
6913 variant field (unless unchecked) is replaced by a particular branch
6914 of the variant.
6915
6916 If not KEEP_DYNAMIC_FIELDS, then all fields whose position or
6917 length are not statically known are discarded. As a consequence,
6918 VALADDR, ADDRESS and DVAL0 are ignored.
6919
6920 NOTE: Limitations: For now, we assume that dynamic fields and
6921 variants occupy whole numbers of bytes. However, they need not be
6922 byte-aligned. */
6923
6924 struct type *
6925 ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 (struct type *type,
6926 const gdb_byte *valaddr,
6927 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0,
6928 int keep_dynamic_fields)
6929 {
6930 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
6931 struct value *dval;
6932 struct type *rtype;
6933 int nfields, bit_len;
6934 int variant_field;
6935 long off;
6936 int fld_bit_len, bit_incr;
6937 int f;
6938
6939 /* Compute the number of fields in this record type that are going
6940 to be processed: unless keep_dynamic_fields, this includes only
6941 fields whose position and length are static will be processed. */
6942 if (keep_dynamic_fields)
6943 nfields = TYPE_NFIELDS (type);
6944 else
6945 {
6946 nfields = 0;
6947 while (nfields < TYPE_NFIELDS (type)
6948 && !ada_is_variant_part (type, nfields)
6949 && !is_dynamic_field (type, nfields))
6950 nfields++;
6951 }
6952
6953 rtype = alloc_type (TYPE_OBJFILE (type));
6954 TYPE_CODE (rtype) = TYPE_CODE_STRUCT;
6955 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (rtype);
6956 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) = nfields;
6957 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype) = (struct field *)
6958 TYPE_ALLOC (rtype, nfields * sizeof (struct field));
6959 memset (TYPE_FIELDS (rtype), 0, sizeof (struct field) * nfields);
6960 TYPE_NAME (rtype) = ada_type_name (type);
6961 TYPE_TAG_NAME (rtype) = NULL;
6962 TYPE_FLAGS (rtype) |= TYPE_FLAG_FIXED_INSTANCE;
6963
6964 off = 0;
6965 bit_len = 0;
6966 variant_field = -1;
6967
6968 for (f = 0; f < nfields; f += 1)
6969 {
6970 off = align_value (off, field_alignment (type, f))
6971 + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, f);
6972 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (rtype, f) = off;
6973 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, f) = 0;
6974
6975 if (ada_is_variant_part (type, f))
6976 {
6977 variant_field = f;
6978 fld_bit_len = bit_incr = 0;
6979 }
6980 else if (is_dynamic_field (type, f))
6981 {
6982 if (dval0 == NULL)
6983 dval = value_from_contents_and_address (rtype, valaddr, address);
6984 else
6985 dval = dval0;
6986
6987 /* Get the fixed type of the field. Note that, in this case, we
6988 do not want to get the real type out of the tag: if the current
6989 field is the parent part of a tagged record, we will get the
6990 tag of the object. Clearly wrong: the real type of the parent
6991 is not the real type of the child. We would end up in an infinite
6992 loop. */
6993 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f) =
6994 ada_to_fixed_type
6995 (ada_get_base_type
6996 (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f))),
6997 cond_offset_host (valaddr, off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT),
6998 cond_offset_target (address, off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT), dval, 0);
6999 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f);
7000 bit_incr = fld_bit_len =
7001 TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
7002 }
7003 else
7004 {
7005 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f);
7006 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f);
7007 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, f) > 0)
7008 bit_incr = fld_bit_len =
7009 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, f);
7010 else
7011 bit_incr = fld_bit_len =
7012 TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
7013 }
7014 if (off + fld_bit_len > bit_len)
7015 bit_len = off + fld_bit_len;
7016 off += bit_incr;
7017 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) =
7018 align_value (bit_len, TARGET_CHAR_BIT) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
7019 }
7020
7021 /* We handle the variant part, if any, at the end because of certain
7022 odd cases in which it is re-ordered so as NOT the last field of
7023 the record. This can happen in the presence of representation
7024 clauses. */
7025 if (variant_field >= 0)
7026 {
7027 struct type *branch_type;
7028
7029 off = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (rtype, variant_field);
7030
7031 if (dval0 == NULL)
7032 dval = value_from_contents_and_address (rtype, valaddr, address);
7033 else
7034 dval = dval0;
7035
7036 branch_type =
7037 to_fixed_variant_branch_type
7038 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field),
7039 cond_offset_host (valaddr, off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT),
7040 cond_offset_target (address, off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT), dval);
7041 if (branch_type == NULL)
7042 {
7043 for (f = variant_field + 1; f < TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype); f += 1)
7044 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f - 1] = TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f];
7045 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) -= 1;
7046 }
7047 else
7048 {
7049 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field) = branch_type;
7050 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, variant_field) = "S";
7051 fld_bit_len =
7052 TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field)) *
7053 TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
7054 if (off + fld_bit_len > bit_len)
7055 bit_len = off + fld_bit_len;
7056 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) =
7057 align_value (bit_len, TARGET_CHAR_BIT) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
7058 }
7059 }
7060
7061 /* According to exp_dbug.ads, the size of TYPE for variable-size records
7062 should contain the alignment of that record, which should be a strictly
7063 positive value. If null or negative, then something is wrong, most
7064 probably in the debug info. In that case, we don't round up the size
7065 of the resulting type. If this record is not part of another structure,
7066 the current RTYPE length might be good enough for our purposes. */
7067 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type) <= 0)
7068 {
7069 if (TYPE_NAME (rtype))
7070 warning (_("Invalid type size for `%s' detected: %d."),
7071 TYPE_NAME (rtype), TYPE_LENGTH (type));
7072 else
7073 warning (_("Invalid type size for <unnamed> detected: %d."),
7074 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
7075 }
7076 else
7077 {
7078 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) = align_value (TYPE_LENGTH (rtype),
7079 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
7080 }
7081
7082 value_free_to_mark (mark);
7083 if (TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) > varsize_limit)
7084 error (_("record type with dynamic size is larger than varsize-limit"));
7085 return rtype;
7086 }
7087
7088 /* As for ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 with KEEP_DYNAMIC_FIELDS
7089 of 1. */
7090
7091 static struct type *
7092 template_to_fixed_record_type (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7093 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0)
7094 {
7095 return ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 (type, valaddr,
7096 address, dval0, 1);
7097 }
7098
7099 /* An ordinary record type in which ___XVL-convention fields and
7100 ___XVU- and ___XVN-convention field types in TYPE0 are replaced with
7101 static approximations, containing all possible fields. Uses
7102 no runtime values. Useless for use in values, but that's OK,
7103 since the results are used only for type determinations. Works on both
7104 structs and unions. Representation note: to save space, we memorize
7105 the result of this function in the TYPE_TARGET_TYPE of the
7106 template type. */
7107
7108 static struct type *
7109 template_to_static_fixed_type (struct type *type0)
7110 {
7111 struct type *type;
7112 int nfields;
7113 int f;
7114
7115 if (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0) != NULL)
7116 return TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0);
7117
7118 nfields = TYPE_NFIELDS (type0);
7119 type = type0;
7120
7121 for (f = 0; f < nfields; f += 1)
7122 {
7123 struct type *field_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type0, f));
7124 struct type *new_type;
7125
7126 if (is_dynamic_field (type0, f))
7127 new_type = to_static_fixed_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (field_type));
7128 else
7129 new_type = static_unwrap_type (field_type);
7130 if (type == type0 && new_type != field_type)
7131 {
7132 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0) = type = alloc_type (TYPE_OBJFILE (type0));
7133 TYPE_CODE (type) = TYPE_CODE (type0);
7134 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (type);
7135 TYPE_NFIELDS (type) = nfields;
7136 TYPE_FIELDS (type) = (struct field *)
7137 TYPE_ALLOC (type, nfields * sizeof (struct field));
7138 memcpy (TYPE_FIELDS (type), TYPE_FIELDS (type0),
7139 sizeof (struct field) * nfields);
7140 TYPE_NAME (type) = ada_type_name (type0);
7141 TYPE_TAG_NAME (type) = NULL;
7142 TYPE_FLAGS (type) |= TYPE_FLAG_FIXED_INSTANCE;
7143 TYPE_LENGTH (type) = 0;
7144 }
7145 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f) = new_type;
7146 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type0, f);
7147 }
7148 return type;
7149 }
7150
7151 /* Given an object of type TYPE whose contents are at VALADDR and
7152 whose address in memory is ADDRESS, returns a revision of TYPE --
7153 a non-dynamic-sized record with a variant part -- in which
7154 the variant part is replaced with the appropriate branch. Looks
7155 for discriminant values in DVAL0, which can be NULL if the record
7156 contains the necessary discriminant values. */
7157
7158 static struct type *
7159 to_record_with_fixed_variant_part (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7160 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0)
7161 {
7162 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
7163 struct value *dval;
7164 struct type *rtype;
7165 struct type *branch_type;
7166 int nfields = TYPE_NFIELDS (type);
7167 int variant_field = variant_field_index (type);
7168
7169 if (variant_field == -1)
7170 return type;
7171
7172 if (dval0 == NULL)
7173 dval = value_from_contents_and_address (type, valaddr, address);
7174 else
7175 dval = dval0;
7176
7177 rtype = alloc_type (TYPE_OBJFILE (type));
7178 TYPE_CODE (rtype) = TYPE_CODE_STRUCT;
7179 INIT_CPLUS_SPECIFIC (rtype);
7180 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) = nfields;
7181 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype) =
7182 (struct field *) TYPE_ALLOC (rtype, nfields * sizeof (struct field));
7183 memcpy (TYPE_FIELDS (rtype), TYPE_FIELDS (type),
7184 sizeof (struct field) * nfields);
7185 TYPE_NAME (rtype) = ada_type_name (type);
7186 TYPE_TAG_NAME (rtype) = NULL;
7187 TYPE_FLAGS (rtype) |= TYPE_FLAG_FIXED_INSTANCE;
7188 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) = TYPE_LENGTH (type);
7189
7190 branch_type = to_fixed_variant_branch_type
7191 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field),
7192 cond_offset_host (valaddr,
7193 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, variant_field)
7194 / TARGET_CHAR_BIT),
7195 cond_offset_target (address,
7196 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, variant_field)
7197 / TARGET_CHAR_BIT), dval);
7198 if (branch_type == NULL)
7199 {
7200 int f;
7201 for (f = variant_field + 1; f < nfields; f += 1)
7202 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f - 1] = TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f];
7203 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) -= 1;
7204 }
7205 else
7206 {
7207 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field) = branch_type;
7208 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, variant_field) = "S";
7209 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, variant_field) = 0;
7210 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) += TYPE_LENGTH (branch_type);
7211 }
7212 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) -= TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field));
7213
7214 value_free_to_mark (mark);
7215 return rtype;
7216 }
7217
7218 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes
7219 the value at (TYPE0, VALADDR, ADDRESS) [see explanation at
7220 beginning of this section]. Any necessary discriminants' values
7221 should be in DVAL, a record value; it may be NULL if the object
7222 at ADDR itself contains any necessary discriminant values.
7223 Additionally, VALADDR and ADDRESS may also be NULL if no discriminant
7224 values from the record are needed. Except in the case that DVAL,
7225 VALADDR, and ADDRESS are all 0 or NULL, a variant field (unless
7226 unchecked) is replaced by a particular branch of the variant.
7227
7228 NOTE: the case in which DVAL and VALADDR are NULL and ADDRESS is 0
7229 is questionable and may be removed. It can arise during the
7230 processing of an unconstrained-array-of-record type where all the
7231 variant branches have exactly the same size. This is because in
7232 such cases, the compiler does not bother to use the XVS convention
7233 when encoding the record. I am currently dubious of this
7234 shortcut and suspect the compiler should be altered. FIXME. */
7235
7236 static struct type *
7237 to_fixed_record_type (struct type *type0, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7238 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval)
7239 {
7240 struct type *templ_type;
7241
7242 if (TYPE_FLAGS (type0) & TYPE_FLAG_FIXED_INSTANCE)
7243 return type0;
7244
7245 templ_type = dynamic_template_type (type0);
7246
7247 if (templ_type != NULL)
7248 return template_to_fixed_record_type (templ_type, valaddr, address, dval);
7249 else if (variant_field_index (type0) >= 0)
7250 {
7251 if (dval == NULL && valaddr == NULL && address == 0)
7252 return type0;
7253 return to_record_with_fixed_variant_part (type0, valaddr, address,
7254 dval);
7255 }
7256 else
7257 {
7258 TYPE_FLAGS (type0) |= TYPE_FLAG_FIXED_INSTANCE;
7259 return type0;
7260 }
7261
7262 }
7263
7264 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes
7265 the value at (VAR_TYPE0, VALADDR, ADDRESS), where VAR_TYPE0 is a
7266 union type. Any necessary discriminants' values should be in DVAL,
7267 a record value. That is, this routine selects the appropriate
7268 branch of the union at ADDR according to the discriminant value
7269 indicated in the union's type name. */
7270
7271 static struct type *
7272 to_fixed_variant_branch_type (struct type *var_type0, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7273 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval)
7274 {
7275 int which;
7276 struct type *templ_type;
7277 struct type *var_type;
7278
7279 if (TYPE_CODE (var_type0) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
7280 var_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (var_type0);
7281 else
7282 var_type = var_type0;
7283
7284 templ_type = ada_find_parallel_type (var_type, "___XVU");
7285
7286 if (templ_type != NULL)
7287 var_type = templ_type;
7288
7289 which =
7290 ada_which_variant_applies (var_type,
7291 value_type (dval), value_contents (dval));
7292
7293 if (which < 0)
7294 return empty_record (TYPE_OBJFILE (var_type));
7295 else if (is_dynamic_field (var_type, which))
7296 return to_fixed_record_type
7297 (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which)),
7298 valaddr, address, dval);
7299 else if (variant_field_index (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which)) >= 0)
7300 return
7301 to_fixed_record_type
7302 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which), valaddr, address, dval);
7303 else
7304 return TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which);
7305 }
7306
7307 /* Assuming that TYPE0 is an array type describing the type of a value
7308 at ADDR, and that DVAL describes a record containing any
7309 discriminants used in TYPE0, returns a type for the value that
7310 contains no dynamic components (that is, no components whose sizes
7311 are determined by run-time quantities). Unless IGNORE_TOO_BIG is
7312 true, gives an error message if the resulting type's size is over
7313 varsize_limit. */
7314
7315 static struct type *
7316 to_fixed_array_type (struct type *type0, struct value *dval,
7317 int ignore_too_big)
7318 {
7319 struct type *index_type_desc;
7320 struct type *result;
7321
7322 if (ada_is_packed_array_type (type0) /* revisit? */
7323 || (TYPE_FLAGS (type0) & TYPE_FLAG_FIXED_INSTANCE))
7324 return type0;
7325
7326 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type (type0, "___XA");
7327 if (index_type_desc == NULL)
7328 {
7329 struct type *elt_type0 = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0));
7330 /* NOTE: elt_type---the fixed version of elt_type0---should never
7331 depend on the contents of the array in properly constructed
7332 debugging data. */
7333 /* Create a fixed version of the array element type.
7334 We're not providing the address of an element here,
7335 and thus the actual object value cannot be inspected to do
7336 the conversion. This should not be a problem, since arrays of
7337 unconstrained objects are not allowed. In particular, all
7338 the elements of an array of a tagged type should all be of
7339 the same type specified in the debugging info. No need to
7340 consult the object tag. */
7341 struct type *elt_type = ada_to_fixed_type (elt_type0, 0, 0, dval, 1);
7342
7343 if (elt_type0 == elt_type)
7344 result = type0;
7345 else
7346 result = create_array_type (alloc_type (TYPE_OBJFILE (type0)),
7347 elt_type, TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type0));
7348 }
7349 else
7350 {
7351 int i;
7352 struct type *elt_type0;
7353
7354 elt_type0 = type0;
7355 for (i = TYPE_NFIELDS (index_type_desc); i > 0; i -= 1)
7356 elt_type0 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type0);
7357
7358 /* NOTE: result---the fixed version of elt_type0---should never
7359 depend on the contents of the array in properly constructed
7360 debugging data. */
7361 /* Create a fixed version of the array element type.
7362 We're not providing the address of an element here,
7363 and thus the actual object value cannot be inspected to do
7364 the conversion. This should not be a problem, since arrays of
7365 unconstrained objects are not allowed. In particular, all
7366 the elements of an array of a tagged type should all be of
7367 the same type specified in the debugging info. No need to
7368 consult the object tag. */
7369 result =
7370 ada_to_fixed_type (ada_check_typedef (elt_type0), 0, 0, dval, 1);
7371 for (i = TYPE_NFIELDS (index_type_desc) - 1; i >= 0; i -= 1)
7372 {
7373 struct type *range_type =
7374 to_fixed_range_type (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (index_type_desc, i),
7375 dval, TYPE_OBJFILE (type0));
7376 result = create_array_type (alloc_type (TYPE_OBJFILE (type0)),
7377 result, range_type);
7378 }
7379 if (!ignore_too_big && TYPE_LENGTH (result) > varsize_limit)
7380 error (_("array type with dynamic size is larger than varsize-limit"));
7381 }
7382
7383 TYPE_FLAGS (result) |= TYPE_FLAG_FIXED_INSTANCE;
7384 return result;
7385 }
7386
7387
7388 /* A standard type (containing no dynamically sized components)
7389 corresponding to TYPE for the value (TYPE, VALADDR, ADDRESS)
7390 DVAL describes a record containing any discriminants used in TYPE0,
7391 and may be NULL if there are none, or if the object of type TYPE at
7392 ADDRESS or in VALADDR contains these discriminants.
7393
7394 If CHECK_TAG is not null, in the case of tagged types, this function
7395 attempts to locate the object's tag and use it to compute the actual
7396 type. However, when ADDRESS is null, we cannot use it to determine the
7397 location of the tag, and therefore compute the tagged type's actual type.
7398 So we return the tagged type without consulting the tag. */
7399
7400 static struct type *
7401 ada_to_fixed_type_1 (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7402 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval, int check_tag)
7403 {
7404 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7405 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
7406 {
7407 default:
7408 return type;
7409 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
7410 {
7411 struct type *static_type = to_static_fixed_type (type);
7412 struct type *fixed_record_type =
7413 to_fixed_record_type (type, valaddr, address, NULL);
7414 /* If STATIC_TYPE is a tagged type and we know the object's address,
7415 then we can determine its tag, and compute the object's actual
7416 type from there. Note that we have to use the fixed record
7417 type (the parent part of the record may have dynamic fields
7418 and the way the location of _tag is expressed may depend on
7419 them). */
7420
7421 if (check_tag && address != 0 && ada_is_tagged_type (static_type, 0))
7422 {
7423 struct type *real_type =
7424 type_from_tag (value_tag_from_contents_and_address
7425 (fixed_record_type,
7426 valaddr,
7427 address));
7428 if (real_type != NULL)
7429 return to_fixed_record_type (real_type, valaddr, address, NULL);
7430 }
7431 return fixed_record_type;
7432 }
7433 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
7434 return to_fixed_array_type (type, dval, 1);
7435 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
7436 if (dval == NULL)
7437 return type;
7438 else
7439 return to_fixed_variant_branch_type (type, valaddr, address, dval);
7440 }
7441 }
7442
7443 /* The same as ada_to_fixed_type_1, except that it preserves the type
7444 if it is a TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF of a type that is already fixed.
7445 ada_to_fixed_type_1 would return the type referenced by TYPE. */
7446
7447 struct type *
7448 ada_to_fixed_type (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
7449 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval, int check_tag)
7450
7451 {
7452 struct type *fixed_type =
7453 ada_to_fixed_type_1 (type, valaddr, address, dval, check_tag);
7454
7455 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
7456 && TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) == fixed_type)
7457 return type;
7458
7459 return fixed_type;
7460 }
7461
7462 /* A standard (static-sized) type corresponding as well as possible to
7463 TYPE0, but based on no runtime data. */
7464
7465 static struct type *
7466 to_static_fixed_type (struct type *type0)
7467 {
7468 struct type *type;
7469
7470 if (type0 == NULL)
7471 return NULL;
7472
7473 if (TYPE_FLAGS (type0) & TYPE_FLAG_FIXED_INSTANCE)
7474 return type0;
7475
7476 type0 = ada_check_typedef (type0);
7477
7478 switch (TYPE_CODE (type0))
7479 {
7480 default:
7481 return type0;
7482 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
7483 type = dynamic_template_type (type0);
7484 if (type != NULL)
7485 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type);
7486 else
7487 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type0);
7488 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
7489 type = ada_find_parallel_type (type0, "___XVU");
7490 if (type != NULL)
7491 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type);
7492 else
7493 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type0);
7494 }
7495 }
7496
7497 /* A static approximation of TYPE with all type wrappers removed. */
7498
7499 static struct type *
7500 static_unwrap_type (struct type *type)
7501 {
7502 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
7503 {
7504 struct type *type1 = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (ada_check_typedef (type), 0);
7505 if (ada_type_name (type1) == NULL)
7506 TYPE_NAME (type1) = ada_type_name (type);
7507
7508 return static_unwrap_type (type1);
7509 }
7510 else
7511 {
7512 struct type *raw_real_type = ada_get_base_type (type);
7513 if (raw_real_type == type)
7514 return type;
7515 else
7516 return to_static_fixed_type (raw_real_type);
7517 }
7518 }
7519
7520 /* In some cases, incomplete and private types require
7521 cross-references that are not resolved as records (for example,
7522 type Foo;
7523 type FooP is access Foo;
7524 V: FooP;
7525 type Foo is array ...;
7526 ). In these cases, since there is no mechanism for producing
7527 cross-references to such types, we instead substitute for FooP a
7528 stub enumeration type that is nowhere resolved, and whose tag is
7529 the name of the actual type. Call these types "non-record stubs". */
7530
7531 /* A type equivalent to TYPE that is not a non-record stub, if one
7532 exists, otherwise TYPE. */
7533
7534 struct type *
7535 ada_check_typedef (struct type *type)
7536 {
7537 if (type == NULL)
7538 return NULL;
7539
7540 CHECK_TYPEDEF (type);
7541 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM
7542 || !TYPE_STUB (type)
7543 || TYPE_TAG_NAME (type) == NULL)
7544 return type;
7545 else
7546 {
7547 char *name = TYPE_TAG_NAME (type);
7548 struct type *type1 = ada_find_any_type (name);
7549 return (type1 == NULL) ? type : type1;
7550 }
7551 }
7552
7553 /* A value representing the data at VALADDR/ADDRESS as described by
7554 type TYPE0, but with a standard (static-sized) type that correctly
7555 describes it. If VAL0 is not NULL and TYPE0 already is a standard
7556 type, then return VAL0 [this feature is simply to avoid redundant
7557 creation of struct values]. */
7558
7559 static struct value *
7560 ada_to_fixed_value_create (struct type *type0, CORE_ADDR address,
7561 struct value *val0)
7562 {
7563 struct type *type = ada_to_fixed_type (type0, 0, address, NULL, 1);
7564 if (type == type0 && val0 != NULL)
7565 return val0;
7566 else
7567 return value_from_contents_and_address (type, 0, address);
7568 }
7569
7570 /* A value representing VAL, but with a standard (static-sized) type
7571 that correctly describes it. Does not necessarily create a new
7572 value. */
7573
7574 static struct value *
7575 ada_to_fixed_value (struct value *val)
7576 {
7577 return ada_to_fixed_value_create (value_type (val),
7578 VALUE_ADDRESS (val) + value_offset (val),
7579 val);
7580 }
7581
7582 /* A value representing VAL, but with a standard (static-sized) type
7583 chosen to approximate the real type of VAL as well as possible, but
7584 without consulting any runtime values. For Ada dynamic-sized
7585 types, therefore, the type of the result is likely to be inaccurate. */
7586
7587 struct value *
7588 ada_to_static_fixed_value (struct value *val)
7589 {
7590 struct type *type =
7591 to_static_fixed_type (static_unwrap_type (value_type (val)));
7592 if (type == value_type (val))
7593 return val;
7594 else
7595 return coerce_unspec_val_to_type (val, type);
7596 }
7597 \f
7598
7599 /* Attributes */
7600
7601 /* Table mapping attribute numbers to names.
7602 NOTE: Keep up to date with enum ada_attribute definition in ada-lang.h. */
7603
7604 static const char *attribute_names[] = {
7605 "<?>",
7606
7607 "first",
7608 "last",
7609 "length",
7610 "image",
7611 "max",
7612 "min",
7613 "modulus",
7614 "pos",
7615 "size",
7616 "tag",
7617 "val",
7618 0
7619 };
7620
7621 const char *
7622 ada_attribute_name (enum exp_opcode n)
7623 {
7624 if (n >= OP_ATR_FIRST && n <= (int) OP_ATR_VAL)
7625 return attribute_names[n - OP_ATR_FIRST + 1];
7626 else
7627 return attribute_names[0];
7628 }
7629
7630 /* Evaluate the 'POS attribute applied to ARG. */
7631
7632 static LONGEST
7633 pos_atr (struct value *arg)
7634 {
7635 struct type *type = value_type (arg);
7636
7637 if (!discrete_type_p (type))
7638 error (_("'POS only defined on discrete types"));
7639
7640 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
7641 {
7642 int i;
7643 LONGEST v = value_as_long (arg);
7644
7645 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
7646 {
7647 if (v == TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i))
7648 return i;
7649 }
7650 error (_("enumeration value is invalid: can't find 'POS"));
7651 }
7652 else
7653 return value_as_long (arg);
7654 }
7655
7656 static struct value *
7657 value_pos_atr (struct value *arg)
7658 {
7659 return value_from_longest (builtin_type_int, pos_atr (arg));
7660 }
7661
7662 /* Evaluate the TYPE'VAL attribute applied to ARG. */
7663
7664 static struct value *
7665 value_val_atr (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
7666 {
7667 if (!discrete_type_p (type))
7668 error (_("'VAL only defined on discrete types"));
7669 if (!integer_type_p (value_type (arg)))
7670 error (_("'VAL requires integral argument"));
7671
7672 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
7673 {
7674 long pos = value_as_long (arg);
7675 if (pos < 0 || pos >= TYPE_NFIELDS (type))
7676 error (_("argument to 'VAL out of range"));
7677 return value_from_longest (type, TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, pos));
7678 }
7679 else
7680 return value_from_longest (type, value_as_long (arg));
7681 }
7682 \f
7683
7684 /* Evaluation */
7685
7686 /* True if TYPE appears to be an Ada character type.
7687 [At the moment, this is true only for Character and Wide_Character;
7688 It is a heuristic test that could stand improvement]. */
7689
7690 int
7691 ada_is_character_type (struct type *type)
7692 {
7693 const char *name;
7694
7695 /* If the type code says it's a character, then assume it really is,
7696 and don't check any further. */
7697 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_CHAR)
7698 return 1;
7699
7700 /* Otherwise, assume it's a character type iff it is a discrete type
7701 with a known character type name. */
7702 name = ada_type_name (type);
7703 return (name != NULL
7704 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_INT
7705 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
7706 && (strcmp (name, "character") == 0
7707 || strcmp (name, "wide_character") == 0
7708 || strcmp (name, "wide_wide_character") == 0
7709 || strcmp (name, "unsigned char") == 0));
7710 }
7711
7712 /* True if TYPE appears to be an Ada string type. */
7713
7714 int
7715 ada_is_string_type (struct type *type)
7716 {
7717 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7718 if (type != NULL
7719 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR
7720 && (ada_is_simple_array_type (type)
7721 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
7722 && ada_array_arity (type) == 1)
7723 {
7724 struct type *elttype = ada_array_element_type (type, 1);
7725
7726 return ada_is_character_type (elttype);
7727 }
7728 else
7729 return 0;
7730 }
7731
7732
7733 /* True if TYPE is a struct type introduced by the compiler to force the
7734 alignment of a value. Such types have a single field with a
7735 distinctive name. */
7736
7737 int
7738 ada_is_aligner_type (struct type *type)
7739 {
7740 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7741
7742 /* If we can find a parallel XVS type, then the XVS type should
7743 be used instead of this type. And hence, this is not an aligner
7744 type. */
7745 if (ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVS") != NULL)
7746 return 0;
7747
7748 return (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
7749 && TYPE_NFIELDS (type) == 1
7750 && strcmp (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, 0), "F") == 0);
7751 }
7752
7753 /* If there is an ___XVS-convention type parallel to SUBTYPE, return
7754 the parallel type. */
7755
7756 struct type *
7757 ada_get_base_type (struct type *raw_type)
7758 {
7759 struct type *real_type_namer;
7760 struct type *raw_real_type;
7761
7762 if (raw_type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (raw_type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
7763 return raw_type;
7764
7765 real_type_namer = ada_find_parallel_type (raw_type, "___XVS");
7766 if (real_type_namer == NULL
7767 || TYPE_CODE (real_type_namer) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
7768 || TYPE_NFIELDS (real_type_namer) != 1)
7769 return raw_type;
7770
7771 raw_real_type = ada_find_any_type (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (real_type_namer, 0));
7772 if (raw_real_type == NULL)
7773 return raw_type;
7774 else
7775 return raw_real_type;
7776 }
7777
7778 /* The type of value designated by TYPE, with all aligners removed. */
7779
7780 struct type *
7781 ada_aligned_type (struct type *type)
7782 {
7783 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
7784 return ada_aligned_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0));
7785 else
7786 return ada_get_base_type (type);
7787 }
7788
7789
7790 /* The address of the aligned value in an object at address VALADDR
7791 having type TYPE. Assumes ada_is_aligner_type (TYPE). */
7792
7793 const gdb_byte *
7794 ada_aligned_value_addr (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr)
7795 {
7796 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
7797 return ada_aligned_value_addr (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0),
7798 valaddr +
7799 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type,
7800 0) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT);
7801 else
7802 return valaddr;
7803 }
7804
7805
7806
7807 /* The printed representation of an enumeration literal with encoded
7808 name NAME. The value is good to the next call of ada_enum_name. */
7809 const char *
7810 ada_enum_name (const char *name)
7811 {
7812 static char *result;
7813 static size_t result_len = 0;
7814 char *tmp;
7815
7816 /* First, unqualify the enumeration name:
7817 1. Search for the last '.' character. If we find one, then skip
7818 all the preceeding characters, the unqualified name starts
7819 right after that dot.
7820 2. Otherwise, we may be debugging on a target where the compiler
7821 translates dots into "__". Search forward for double underscores,
7822 but stop searching when we hit an overloading suffix, which is
7823 of the form "__" followed by digits. */
7824
7825 tmp = strrchr (name, '.');
7826 if (tmp != NULL)
7827 name = tmp + 1;
7828 else
7829 {
7830 while ((tmp = strstr (name, "__")) != NULL)
7831 {
7832 if (isdigit (tmp[2]))
7833 break;
7834 else
7835 name = tmp + 2;
7836 }
7837 }
7838
7839 if (name[0] == 'Q')
7840 {
7841 int v;
7842 if (name[1] == 'U' || name[1] == 'W')
7843 {
7844 if (sscanf (name + 2, "%x", &v) != 1)
7845 return name;
7846 }
7847 else
7848 return name;
7849
7850 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, 16);
7851 if (isascii (v) && isprint (v))
7852 sprintf (result, "'%c'", v);
7853 else if (name[1] == 'U')
7854 sprintf (result, "[\"%02x\"]", v);
7855 else
7856 sprintf (result, "[\"%04x\"]", v);
7857
7858 return result;
7859 }
7860 else
7861 {
7862 tmp = strstr (name, "__");
7863 if (tmp == NULL)
7864 tmp = strstr (name, "$");
7865 if (tmp != NULL)
7866 {
7867 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, tmp - name + 1);
7868 strncpy (result, name, tmp - name);
7869 result[tmp - name] = '\0';
7870 return result;
7871 }
7872
7873 return name;
7874 }
7875 }
7876
7877 static struct value *
7878 evaluate_subexp (struct type *expect_type, struct expression *exp, int *pos,
7879 enum noside noside)
7880 {
7881 return (*exp->language_defn->la_exp_desc->evaluate_exp)
7882 (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
7883 }
7884
7885 /* Evaluate the subexpression of EXP starting at *POS as for
7886 evaluate_type, updating *POS to point just past the evaluated
7887 expression. */
7888
7889 static struct value *
7890 evaluate_subexp_type (struct expression *exp, int *pos)
7891 {
7892 return (*exp->language_defn->la_exp_desc->evaluate_exp)
7893 (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS);
7894 }
7895
7896 /* If VAL is wrapped in an aligner or subtype wrapper, return the
7897 value it wraps. */
7898
7899 static struct value *
7900 unwrap_value (struct value *val)
7901 {
7902 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (val));
7903 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
7904 {
7905 struct value *v = ada_value_struct_elt (val, "F", 0);
7906 struct type *val_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (v));
7907 if (ada_type_name (val_type) == NULL)
7908 TYPE_NAME (val_type) = ada_type_name (type);
7909
7910 return unwrap_value (v);
7911 }
7912 else
7913 {
7914 struct type *raw_real_type =
7915 ada_check_typedef (ada_get_base_type (type));
7916
7917 if (type == raw_real_type)
7918 return val;
7919
7920 return
7921 coerce_unspec_val_to_type
7922 (val, ada_to_fixed_type (raw_real_type, 0,
7923 VALUE_ADDRESS (val) + value_offset (val),
7924 NULL, 1));
7925 }
7926 }
7927
7928 static struct value *
7929 cast_to_fixed (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
7930 {
7931 LONGEST val;
7932
7933 if (type == value_type (arg))
7934 return arg;
7935 else if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg)))
7936 val = ada_float_to_fixed (type,
7937 ada_fixed_to_float (value_type (arg),
7938 value_as_long (arg)));
7939 else
7940 {
7941 DOUBLEST argd =
7942 value_as_double (value_cast (builtin_type_double, value_copy (arg)));
7943 val = ada_float_to_fixed (type, argd);
7944 }
7945
7946 return value_from_longest (type, val);
7947 }
7948
7949 static struct value *
7950 cast_from_fixed_to_double (struct value *arg)
7951 {
7952 DOUBLEST val = ada_fixed_to_float (value_type (arg),
7953 value_as_long (arg));
7954 return value_from_double (builtin_type_double, val);
7955 }
7956
7957 /* Coerce VAL as necessary for assignment to an lval of type TYPE, and
7958 return the converted value. */
7959
7960 static struct value *
7961 coerce_for_assign (struct type *type, struct value *val)
7962 {
7963 struct type *type2 = value_type (val);
7964 if (type == type2)
7965 return val;
7966
7967 type2 = ada_check_typedef (type2);
7968 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7969
7970 if (TYPE_CODE (type2) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
7971 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
7972 {
7973 val = ada_value_ind (val);
7974 type2 = value_type (val);
7975 }
7976
7977 if (TYPE_CODE (type2) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
7978 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
7979 {
7980 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type2) != TYPE_LENGTH (type)
7981 || TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type2))
7982 != TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type2)))
7983 error (_("Incompatible types in assignment"));
7984 deprecated_set_value_type (val, type);
7985 }
7986 return val;
7987 }
7988
7989 static struct value *
7990 ada_value_binop (struct value *arg1, struct value *arg2, enum exp_opcode op)
7991 {
7992 struct value *val;
7993 struct type *type1, *type2;
7994 LONGEST v, v1, v2;
7995
7996 arg1 = coerce_ref (arg1);
7997 arg2 = coerce_ref (arg2);
7998 type1 = base_type (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1)));
7999 type2 = base_type (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg2)));
8000
8001 if (TYPE_CODE (type1) != TYPE_CODE_INT
8002 || TYPE_CODE (type2) != TYPE_CODE_INT)
8003 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
8004
8005 switch (op)
8006 {
8007 case BINOP_MOD:
8008 case BINOP_DIV:
8009 case BINOP_REM:
8010 break;
8011 default:
8012 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
8013 }
8014
8015 v2 = value_as_long (arg2);
8016 if (v2 == 0)
8017 error (_("second operand of %s must not be zero."), op_string (op));
8018
8019 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type1) || op == BINOP_MOD)
8020 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
8021
8022 v1 = value_as_long (arg1);
8023 switch (op)
8024 {
8025 case BINOP_DIV:
8026 v = v1 / v2;
8027 if (!TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO && v1 * (v1 % v2) < 0)
8028 v += v > 0 ? -1 : 1;
8029 break;
8030 case BINOP_REM:
8031 v = v1 % v2;
8032 if (v * v1 < 0)
8033 v -= v2;
8034 break;
8035 default:
8036 /* Should not reach this point. */
8037 v = 0;
8038 }
8039
8040 val = allocate_value (type1);
8041 store_unsigned_integer (value_contents_raw (val),
8042 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (val)), v);
8043 return val;
8044 }
8045
8046 static int
8047 ada_value_equal (struct value *arg1, struct value *arg2)
8048 {
8049 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (arg1))
8050 || ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (arg2)))
8051 {
8052 /* Automatically dereference any array reference before
8053 we attempt to perform the comparison. */
8054 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1);
8055 arg2 = ada_coerce_ref (arg2);
8056
8057 arg1 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1);
8058 arg2 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg2);
8059 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg1)) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
8060 || TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg2)) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
8061 error (_("Attempt to compare array with non-array"));
8062 /* FIXME: The following works only for types whose
8063 representations use all bits (no padding or undefined bits)
8064 and do not have user-defined equality. */
8065 return
8066 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arg1)) == TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arg2))
8067 && memcmp (value_contents (arg1), value_contents (arg2),
8068 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arg1))) == 0;
8069 }
8070 return value_equal (arg1, arg2);
8071 }
8072
8073 /* Total number of component associations in the aggregate starting at
8074 index PC in EXP. Assumes that index PC is the start of an
8075 OP_AGGREGATE. */
8076
8077 static int
8078 num_component_specs (struct expression *exp, int pc)
8079 {
8080 int n, m, i;
8081 m = exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst;
8082 pc += 3;
8083 n = 0;
8084 for (i = 0; i < m; i += 1)
8085 {
8086 switch (exp->elts[pc].opcode)
8087 {
8088 default:
8089 n += 1;
8090 break;
8091 case OP_CHOICES:
8092 n += exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst;
8093 break;
8094 }
8095 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &pc, EVAL_SKIP);
8096 }
8097 return n;
8098 }
8099
8100 /* Assign the result of evaluating EXP starting at *POS to the INDEXth
8101 component of LHS (a simple array or a record), updating *POS past
8102 the expression, assuming that LHS is contained in CONTAINER. Does
8103 not modify the inferior's memory, nor does it modify LHS (unless
8104 LHS == CONTAINER). */
8105
8106 static void
8107 assign_component (struct value *container, struct value *lhs, LONGEST index,
8108 struct expression *exp, int *pos)
8109 {
8110 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
8111 struct value *elt;
8112 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (lhs)) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
8113 {
8114 struct value *index_val = value_from_longest (builtin_type_int, index);
8115 elt = unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript (lhs, 1, &index_val));
8116 }
8117 else
8118 {
8119 elt = ada_index_struct_field (index, lhs, 0, value_type (lhs));
8120 elt = ada_to_fixed_value (unwrap_value (elt));
8121 }
8122
8123 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_AGGREGATE)
8124 assign_aggregate (container, elt, exp, pos, EVAL_NORMAL);
8125 else
8126 value_assign_to_component (container, elt,
8127 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos,
8128 EVAL_NORMAL));
8129
8130 value_free_to_mark (mark);
8131 }
8132
8133 /* Assuming that LHS represents an lvalue having a record or array
8134 type, and EXP->ELTS[*POS] is an OP_AGGREGATE, evaluate an assignment
8135 of that aggregate's value to LHS, advancing *POS past the
8136 aggregate. NOSIDE is as for evaluate_subexp. CONTAINER is an
8137 lvalue containing LHS (possibly LHS itself). Does not modify
8138 the inferior's memory, nor does it modify the contents of
8139 LHS (unless == CONTAINER). Returns the modified CONTAINER. */
8140
8141 static struct value *
8142 assign_aggregate (struct value *container,
8143 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
8144 int *pos, enum noside noside)
8145 {
8146 struct type *lhs_type;
8147 int n = exp->elts[*pos+1].longconst;
8148 LONGEST low_index, high_index;
8149 int num_specs;
8150 LONGEST *indices;
8151 int max_indices, num_indices;
8152 int is_array_aggregate;
8153 int i;
8154 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
8155
8156 *pos += 3;
8157 if (noside != EVAL_NORMAL)
8158 {
8159 int i;
8160 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1)
8161 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, noside);
8162 return container;
8163 }
8164
8165 container = ada_coerce_ref (container);
8166 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (container)))
8167 container = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (container);
8168 lhs = ada_coerce_ref (lhs);
8169 if (!deprecated_value_modifiable (lhs))
8170 error (_("Left operand of assignment is not a modifiable lvalue."));
8171
8172 lhs_type = value_type (lhs);
8173 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (lhs_type))
8174 {
8175 lhs = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (lhs);
8176 lhs_type = value_type (lhs);
8177 low_index = TYPE_ARRAY_LOWER_BOUND_VALUE (lhs_type);
8178 high_index = TYPE_ARRAY_UPPER_BOUND_VALUE (lhs_type);
8179 is_array_aggregate = 1;
8180 }
8181 else if (TYPE_CODE (lhs_type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
8182 {
8183 low_index = 0;
8184 high_index = num_visible_fields (lhs_type) - 1;
8185 is_array_aggregate = 0;
8186 }
8187 else
8188 error (_("Left-hand side must be array or record."));
8189
8190 num_specs = num_component_specs (exp, *pos - 3);
8191 max_indices = 4 * num_specs + 4;
8192 indices = alloca (max_indices * sizeof (indices[0]));
8193 indices[0] = indices[1] = low_index - 1;
8194 indices[2] = indices[3] = high_index + 1;
8195 num_indices = 4;
8196
8197 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1)
8198 {
8199 switch (exp->elts[*pos].opcode)
8200 {
8201 case OP_CHOICES:
8202 aggregate_assign_from_choices (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices,
8203 &num_indices, max_indices,
8204 low_index, high_index);
8205 break;
8206 case OP_POSITIONAL:
8207 aggregate_assign_positional (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices,
8208 &num_indices, max_indices,
8209 low_index, high_index);
8210 break;
8211 case OP_OTHERS:
8212 if (i != n-1)
8213 error (_("Misplaced 'others' clause"));
8214 aggregate_assign_others (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices,
8215 num_indices, low_index, high_index);
8216 break;
8217 default:
8218 error (_("Internal error: bad aggregate clause"));
8219 }
8220 }
8221
8222 return container;
8223 }
8224
8225 /* Assign into the component of LHS indexed by the OP_POSITIONAL
8226 construct at *POS, updating *POS past the construct, given that
8227 the positions are relative to lower bound LOW, where HIGH is the
8228 upper bound. Record the position in INDICES[0 .. MAX_INDICES-1]
8229 updating *NUM_INDICES as needed. CONTAINER is as for
8230 assign_aggregate. */
8231 static void
8232 aggregate_assign_positional (struct value *container,
8233 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
8234 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int *num_indices,
8235 int max_indices, LONGEST low, LONGEST high)
8236 {
8237 LONGEST ind = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos + 1].longconst) + low;
8238
8239 if (ind - 1 == high)
8240 warning (_("Extra components in aggregate ignored."));
8241 if (ind <= high)
8242 {
8243 add_component_interval (ind, ind, indices, num_indices, max_indices);
8244 *pos += 3;
8245 assign_component (container, lhs, ind, exp, pos);
8246 }
8247 else
8248 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
8249 }
8250
8251 /* Assign into the components of LHS indexed by the OP_CHOICES
8252 construct at *POS, updating *POS past the construct, given that
8253 the allowable indices are LOW..HIGH. Record the indices assigned
8254 to in INDICES[0 .. MAX_INDICES-1], updating *NUM_INDICES as
8255 needed. CONTAINER is as for assign_aggregate. */
8256 static void
8257 aggregate_assign_from_choices (struct value *container,
8258 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
8259 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int *num_indices,
8260 int max_indices, LONGEST low, LONGEST high)
8261 {
8262 int j;
8263 int n_choices = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos+1].longconst);
8264 int choice_pos, expr_pc;
8265 int is_array = ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (lhs));
8266
8267 choice_pos = *pos += 3;
8268
8269 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1)
8270 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
8271 expr_pc = *pos;
8272 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
8273
8274 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1)
8275 {
8276 LONGEST lower, upper;
8277 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[choice_pos].opcode;
8278 if (op == OP_DISCRETE_RANGE)
8279 {
8280 choice_pos += 1;
8281 lower = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos,
8282 EVAL_NORMAL));
8283 upper = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos,
8284 EVAL_NORMAL));
8285 }
8286 else if (is_array)
8287 {
8288 lower = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &choice_pos,
8289 EVAL_NORMAL));
8290 upper = lower;
8291 }
8292 else
8293 {
8294 int ind;
8295 char *name;
8296 switch (op)
8297 {
8298 case OP_NAME:
8299 name = &exp->elts[choice_pos + 2].string;
8300 break;
8301 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
8302 name = SYMBOL_NATURAL_NAME (exp->elts[choice_pos + 2].symbol);
8303 break;
8304 default:
8305 error (_("Invalid record component association."));
8306 }
8307 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &choice_pos, EVAL_SKIP);
8308 ind = 0;
8309 if (! find_struct_field (name, value_type (lhs), 0,
8310 NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, &ind))
8311 error (_("Unknown component name: %s."), name);
8312 lower = upper = ind;
8313 }
8314
8315 if (lower <= upper && (lower < low || upper > high))
8316 error (_("Index in component association out of bounds."));
8317
8318 add_component_interval (lower, upper, indices, num_indices,
8319 max_indices);
8320 while (lower <= upper)
8321 {
8322 int pos1;
8323 pos1 = expr_pc;
8324 assign_component (container, lhs, lower, exp, &pos1);
8325 lower += 1;
8326 }
8327 }
8328 }
8329
8330 /* Assign the value of the expression in the OP_OTHERS construct in
8331 EXP at *POS into the components of LHS indexed from LOW .. HIGH that
8332 have not been previously assigned. The index intervals already assigned
8333 are in INDICES[0 .. NUM_INDICES-1]. Updates *POS to after the
8334 OP_OTHERS clause. CONTAINER is as for assign_aggregate*/
8335 static void
8336 aggregate_assign_others (struct value *container,
8337 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
8338 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int num_indices,
8339 LONGEST low, LONGEST high)
8340 {
8341 int i;
8342 int expr_pc = *pos+1;
8343
8344 for (i = 0; i < num_indices - 2; i += 2)
8345 {
8346 LONGEST ind;
8347 for (ind = indices[i + 1] + 1; ind < indices[i + 2]; ind += 1)
8348 {
8349 int pos;
8350 pos = expr_pc;
8351 assign_component (container, lhs, ind, exp, &pos);
8352 }
8353 }
8354 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
8355 }
8356
8357 /* Add the interval [LOW .. HIGH] to the sorted set of intervals
8358 [ INDICES[0] .. INDICES[1] ],..., [ INDICES[*SIZE-2] .. INDICES[*SIZE-1] ],
8359 modifying *SIZE as needed. It is an error if *SIZE exceeds
8360 MAX_SIZE. The resulting intervals do not overlap. */
8361 static void
8362 add_component_interval (LONGEST low, LONGEST high,
8363 LONGEST* indices, int *size, int max_size)
8364 {
8365 int i, j;
8366 for (i = 0; i < *size; i += 2) {
8367 if (high >= indices[i] && low <= indices[i + 1])
8368 {
8369 int kh;
8370 for (kh = i + 2; kh < *size; kh += 2)
8371 if (high < indices[kh])
8372 break;
8373 if (low < indices[i])
8374 indices[i] = low;
8375 indices[i + 1] = indices[kh - 1];
8376 if (high > indices[i + 1])
8377 indices[i + 1] = high;
8378 memcpy (indices + i + 2, indices + kh, *size - kh);
8379 *size -= kh - i - 2;
8380 return;
8381 }
8382 else if (high < indices[i])
8383 break;
8384 }
8385
8386 if (*size == max_size)
8387 error (_("Internal error: miscounted aggregate components."));
8388 *size += 2;
8389 for (j = *size-1; j >= i+2; j -= 1)
8390 indices[j] = indices[j - 2];
8391 indices[i] = low;
8392 indices[i + 1] = high;
8393 }
8394
8395 /* Perform and Ada cast of ARG2 to type TYPE if the type of ARG2
8396 is different. */
8397
8398 static struct value *
8399 ada_value_cast (struct type *type, struct value *arg2, enum noside noside)
8400 {
8401 if (type == ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg2)))
8402 return arg2;
8403
8404 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (type))
8405 return (cast_to_fixed (type, arg2));
8406
8407 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
8408 return value_cast (type, cast_from_fixed_to_double (arg2));
8409
8410 return value_cast (type, arg2);
8411 }
8412
8413 static struct value *
8414 ada_evaluate_subexp (struct type *expect_type, struct expression *exp,
8415 int *pos, enum noside noside)
8416 {
8417 enum exp_opcode op;
8418 int tem, tem2, tem3;
8419 int pc;
8420 struct value *arg1 = NULL, *arg2 = NULL, *arg3;
8421 struct type *type;
8422 int nargs, oplen;
8423 struct value **argvec;
8424
8425 pc = *pos;
8426 *pos += 1;
8427 op = exp->elts[pc].opcode;
8428
8429 switch (op)
8430 {
8431 default:
8432 *pos -= 1;
8433 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
8434 arg1 = unwrap_value (arg1);
8435
8436 /* If evaluating an OP_DOUBLE and an EXPECT_TYPE was provided,
8437 then we need to perform the conversion manually, because
8438 evaluate_subexp_standard doesn't do it. This conversion is
8439 necessary in Ada because the different kinds of float/fixed
8440 types in Ada have different representations.
8441
8442 Similarly, we need to perform the conversion from OP_LONG
8443 ourselves. */
8444 if ((op == OP_DOUBLE || op == OP_LONG) && expect_type != NULL)
8445 arg1 = ada_value_cast (expect_type, arg1, noside);
8446
8447 return arg1;
8448
8449 case OP_STRING:
8450 {
8451 struct value *result;
8452 *pos -= 1;
8453 result = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
8454 /* The result type will have code OP_STRING, bashed there from
8455 OP_ARRAY. Bash it back. */
8456 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (result)) == TYPE_CODE_STRING)
8457 TYPE_CODE (value_type (result)) = TYPE_CODE_ARRAY;
8458 return result;
8459 }
8460
8461 case UNOP_CAST:
8462 (*pos) += 2;
8463 type = exp->elts[pc + 1].type;
8464 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (type, exp, pos, noside);
8465 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8466 goto nosideret;
8467 arg1 = ada_value_cast (type, arg1, noside);
8468 return arg1;
8469
8470 case UNOP_QUAL:
8471 (*pos) += 2;
8472 type = exp->elts[pc + 1].type;
8473 return ada_evaluate_subexp (type, exp, pos, noside);
8474
8475 case BINOP_ASSIGN:
8476 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8477 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_AGGREGATE)
8478 {
8479 arg1 = assign_aggregate (arg1, arg1, exp, pos, noside);
8480 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8481 return arg1;
8482 return ada_value_assign (arg1, arg1);
8483 }
8484 /* Force the evaluation of the rhs ARG2 to the type of the lhs ARG1,
8485 except if the lhs of our assignment is a convenience variable.
8486 In the case of assigning to a convenience variable, the lhs
8487 should be exactly the result of the evaluation of the rhs. */
8488 type = value_type (arg1);
8489 if (VALUE_LVAL (arg1) == lval_internalvar)
8490 type = NULL;
8491 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (type, exp, pos, noside);
8492 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8493 return arg1;
8494 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)))
8495 arg2 = cast_to_fixed (value_type (arg1), arg2);
8496 else if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
8497 error
8498 (_("Fixed-point values must be assigned to fixed-point variables"));
8499 else
8500 arg2 = coerce_for_assign (value_type (arg1), arg2);
8501 return ada_value_assign (arg1, arg2);
8502
8503 case BINOP_ADD:
8504 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
8505 arg2 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
8506 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8507 goto nosideret;
8508 if ((ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1))
8509 || ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
8510 && value_type (arg1) != value_type (arg2))
8511 error (_("Operands of fixed-point addition must have the same type"));
8512 /* Do the addition, and cast the result to the type of the first
8513 argument. We cannot cast the result to a reference type, so if
8514 ARG1 is a reference type, find its underlying type. */
8515 type = value_type (arg1);
8516 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
8517 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
8518 return value_cast (type, value_add (arg1, arg2));
8519
8520 case BINOP_SUB:
8521 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
8522 arg2 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
8523 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8524 goto nosideret;
8525 if ((ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1))
8526 || ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
8527 && value_type (arg1) != value_type (arg2))
8528 error (_("Operands of fixed-point subtraction must have the same type"));
8529 /* Do the substraction, and cast the result to the type of the first
8530 argument. We cannot cast the result to a reference type, so if
8531 ARG1 is a reference type, find its underlying type. */
8532 type = value_type (arg1);
8533 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
8534 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
8535 return value_cast (type, value_sub (arg1, arg2));
8536
8537 case BINOP_MUL:
8538 case BINOP_DIV:
8539 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8540 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8541 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8542 goto nosideret;
8543 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS
8544 && (op == BINOP_DIV || op == BINOP_REM || op == BINOP_MOD))
8545 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
8546 else
8547 {
8548 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)))
8549 arg1 = cast_from_fixed_to_double (arg1);
8550 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
8551 arg2 = cast_from_fixed_to_double (arg2);
8552 return ada_value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
8553 }
8554
8555 case BINOP_REM:
8556 case BINOP_MOD:
8557 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8558 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8559 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8560 goto nosideret;
8561 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS
8562 && (op == BINOP_DIV || op == BINOP_REM || op == BINOP_MOD))
8563 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
8564 else
8565 return ada_value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
8566
8567 case BINOP_EQUAL:
8568 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
8569 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8570 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (value_type (arg1), exp, pos, noside);
8571 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8572 goto nosideret;
8573 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8574 tem = 0;
8575 else
8576 tem = ada_value_equal (arg1, arg2);
8577 if (op == BINOP_NOTEQUAL)
8578 tem = !tem;
8579 return value_from_longest (LA_BOOL_TYPE, (LONGEST) tem);
8580
8581 case UNOP_NEG:
8582 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8583 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8584 goto nosideret;
8585 else if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)))
8586 return value_cast (value_type (arg1), value_neg (arg1));
8587 else
8588 return value_neg (arg1);
8589
8590 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
8591 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
8592 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
8593 {
8594 struct value *val;
8595
8596 *pos -= 1;
8597 val = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
8598 return value_cast (LA_BOOL_TYPE, val);
8599 }
8600
8601 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
8602 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
8603 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
8604 {
8605 struct value *val;
8606
8607 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS);
8608 *pos = pc;
8609 val = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
8610
8611 return value_cast (value_type (arg1), val);
8612 }
8613
8614 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
8615 *pos -= 1;
8616
8617 /* Tagged types are a little special in the fact that the real type
8618 is dynamic and can only be determined by inspecting the object
8619 value. So even if we're support to do an EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS
8620 evaluation, we force an EVAL_NORMAL evaluation for tagged types. */
8621 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS
8622 && ada_is_tagged_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol), 1))
8623 noside = EVAL_NORMAL;
8624
8625 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8626 {
8627 *pos += 4;
8628 goto nosideret;
8629 }
8630 else if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
8631 /* Only encountered when an unresolved symbol occurs in a
8632 context other than a function call, in which case, it is
8633 invalid. */
8634 error (_("Unexpected unresolved symbol, %s, during evaluation"),
8635 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
8636 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8637 {
8638 *pos += 4;
8639 return value_zero
8640 (to_static_fixed_type
8641 (static_unwrap_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol))),
8642 not_lval);
8643 }
8644 else
8645 {
8646 arg1 =
8647 unwrap_value (evaluate_subexp_standard
8648 (expect_type, exp, pos, noside));
8649 return ada_to_fixed_value (arg1);
8650 }
8651
8652 case OP_FUNCALL:
8653 (*pos) += 2;
8654
8655 /* Allocate arg vector, including space for the function to be
8656 called in argvec[0] and a terminating NULL. */
8657 nargs = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
8658 argvec =
8659 (struct value **) alloca (sizeof (struct value *) * (nargs + 2));
8660
8661 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE
8662 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
8663 error (_("Unexpected unresolved symbol, %s, during evaluation"),
8664 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol));
8665 else
8666 {
8667 for (tem = 0; tem <= nargs; tem += 1)
8668 argvec[tem] = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8669 argvec[tem] = 0;
8670
8671 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8672 goto nosideret;
8673 }
8674
8675 if (ada_is_packed_array_type (desc_base_type (value_type (argvec[0]))))
8676 argvec[0] = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (argvec[0]);
8677 else if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (argvec[0])) == TYPE_CODE_REF
8678 || (TYPE_CODE (value_type (argvec[0])) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
8679 && VALUE_LVAL (argvec[0]) == lval_memory))
8680 argvec[0] = value_addr (argvec[0]);
8681
8682 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (argvec[0]));
8683 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
8684 {
8685 switch (TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))))
8686 {
8687 case TYPE_CODE_FUNC:
8688 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
8689 break;
8690 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
8691 break;
8692 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
8693 if (noside != EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8694 argvec[0] = ada_value_ind (argvec[0]);
8695 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
8696 break;
8697 default:
8698 error (_("cannot subscript or call something of type `%s'"),
8699 ada_type_name (value_type (argvec[0])));
8700 break;
8701 }
8702 }
8703
8704 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
8705 {
8706 case TYPE_CODE_FUNC:
8707 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8708 return allocate_value (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
8709 return call_function_by_hand (argvec[0], nargs, argvec + 1);
8710 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
8711 {
8712 int arity;
8713
8714 arity = ada_array_arity (type);
8715 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs);
8716 if (type == NULL)
8717 error (_("cannot subscript or call a record"));
8718 if (arity != nargs)
8719 error (_("wrong number of subscripts; expecting %d"), arity);
8720 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8721 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
8722 return
8723 unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript
8724 (argvec[0], nargs, argvec + 1));
8725 }
8726 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
8727 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8728 {
8729 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs);
8730 if (type == NULL)
8731 error (_("element type of array unknown"));
8732 else
8733 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
8734 }
8735 return
8736 unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript
8737 (ada_coerce_to_simple_array (argvec[0]),
8738 nargs, argvec + 1));
8739 case TYPE_CODE_PTR: /* Pointer to array */
8740 type = to_fixed_array_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), NULL, 1);
8741 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8742 {
8743 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs);
8744 if (type == NULL)
8745 error (_("element type of array unknown"));
8746 else
8747 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
8748 }
8749 return
8750 unwrap_value (ada_value_ptr_subscript (argvec[0], type,
8751 nargs, argvec + 1));
8752
8753 default:
8754 error (_("Attempt to index or call something other than an "
8755 "array or function"));
8756 }
8757
8758 case TERNOP_SLICE:
8759 {
8760 struct value *array = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8761 struct value *low_bound_val =
8762 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8763 struct value *high_bound_val =
8764 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8765 LONGEST low_bound;
8766 LONGEST high_bound;
8767 low_bound_val = coerce_ref (low_bound_val);
8768 high_bound_val = coerce_ref (high_bound_val);
8769 low_bound = pos_atr (low_bound_val);
8770 high_bound = pos_atr (high_bound_val);
8771
8772 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8773 goto nosideret;
8774
8775 /* If this is a reference to an aligner type, then remove all
8776 the aligners. */
8777 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_REF
8778 && ada_is_aligner_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array))))
8779 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)) =
8780 ada_aligned_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)));
8781
8782 if (ada_is_packed_array_type (value_type (array)))
8783 error (_("cannot slice a packed array"));
8784
8785 /* If this is a reference to an array or an array lvalue,
8786 convert to a pointer. */
8787 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_REF
8788 || (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
8789 && VALUE_LVAL (array) == lval_memory))
8790 array = value_addr (array);
8791
8792 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS
8793 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (ada_check_typedef
8794 (value_type (array))))
8795 return empty_array (ada_type_of_array (array, 0), low_bound);
8796
8797 array = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (array);
8798
8799 /* If we have more than one level of pointer indirection,
8800 dereference the value until we get only one level. */
8801 while (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
8802 && (TYPE_CODE (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)))
8803 == TYPE_CODE_PTR))
8804 array = value_ind (array);
8805
8806 /* Make sure we really do have an array type before going further,
8807 to avoid a SEGV when trying to get the index type or the target
8808 type later down the road if the debug info generated by
8809 the compiler is incorrect or incomplete. */
8810 if (!ada_is_simple_array_type (value_type (array)))
8811 error (_("cannot take slice of non-array"));
8812
8813 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
8814 {
8815 if (high_bound < low_bound || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8816 return empty_array (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)),
8817 low_bound);
8818 else
8819 {
8820 struct type *arr_type0 =
8821 to_fixed_array_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)),
8822 NULL, 1);
8823 return ada_value_slice_ptr (array, arr_type0,
8824 longest_to_int (low_bound),
8825 longest_to_int (high_bound));
8826 }
8827 }
8828 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8829 return array;
8830 else if (high_bound < low_bound)
8831 return empty_array (value_type (array), low_bound);
8832 else
8833 return ada_value_slice (array, longest_to_int (low_bound),
8834 longest_to_int (high_bound));
8835 }
8836
8837 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
8838 (*pos) += 2;
8839 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8840 type = exp->elts[pc + 1].type;
8841
8842 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8843 goto nosideret;
8844
8845 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
8846 {
8847 default:
8848 lim_warning (_("Membership test incompletely implemented; "
8849 "always returns true"));
8850 return value_from_longest (builtin_type_int, (LONGEST) 1);
8851
8852 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
8853 arg2 = value_from_longest (builtin_type_int, TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type));
8854 arg3 = value_from_longest (builtin_type_int,
8855 TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type));
8856 return
8857 value_from_longest (builtin_type_int,
8858 (value_less (arg1, arg3)
8859 || value_equal (arg1, arg3))
8860 && (value_less (arg2, arg1)
8861 || value_equal (arg2, arg1)));
8862 }
8863
8864 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
8865 (*pos) += 2;
8866 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8867 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8868
8869 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8870 goto nosideret;
8871
8872 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8873 return value_zero (builtin_type_int, not_lval);
8874
8875 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
8876
8877 if (tem < 1 || tem > ada_array_arity (value_type (arg2)))
8878 error (_("invalid dimension number to 'range"));
8879
8880 arg3 = ada_array_bound (arg2, tem, 1);
8881 arg2 = ada_array_bound (arg2, tem, 0);
8882
8883 return
8884 value_from_longest (builtin_type_int,
8885 (value_less (arg1, arg3)
8886 || value_equal (arg1, arg3))
8887 && (value_less (arg2, arg1)
8888 || value_equal (arg2, arg1)));
8889
8890 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
8891 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8892 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8893 arg3 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8894
8895 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8896 goto nosideret;
8897
8898 return
8899 value_from_longest (builtin_type_int,
8900 (value_less (arg1, arg3)
8901 || value_equal (arg1, arg3))
8902 && (value_less (arg2, arg1)
8903 || value_equal (arg2, arg1)));
8904
8905 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
8906 case OP_ATR_LAST:
8907 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
8908 {
8909 struct type *type_arg;
8910 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_TYPE)
8911 {
8912 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
8913 arg1 = NULL;
8914 type_arg = exp->elts[pc + 2].type;
8915 }
8916 else
8917 {
8918 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
8919 type_arg = NULL;
8920 }
8921
8922 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode != OP_LONG)
8923 error (_("Invalid operand to '%s"), ada_attribute_name (op));
8924 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos + 2].longconst);
8925 *pos += 4;
8926
8927 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
8928 goto nosideret;
8929
8930 if (type_arg == NULL)
8931 {
8932 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1);
8933
8934 if (ada_is_packed_array_type (value_type (arg1)))
8935 arg1 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1);
8936
8937 if (tem < 1 || tem > ada_array_arity (value_type (arg1)))
8938 error (_("invalid dimension number to '%s"),
8939 ada_attribute_name (op));
8940
8941 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
8942 {
8943 type = ada_index_type (value_type (arg1), tem);
8944 if (type == NULL)
8945 error
8946 (_("attempt to take bound of something that is not an array"));
8947 return allocate_value (type);
8948 }
8949
8950 switch (op)
8951 {
8952 default: /* Should never happen. */
8953 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
8954 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
8955 return ada_array_bound (arg1, tem, 0);
8956 case OP_ATR_LAST:
8957 return ada_array_bound (arg1, tem, 1);
8958 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
8959 return ada_array_length (arg1, tem);
8960 }
8961 }
8962 else if (discrete_type_p (type_arg))
8963 {
8964 struct type *range_type;
8965 char *name = ada_type_name (type_arg);
8966 range_type = NULL;
8967 if (name != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type_arg) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
8968 range_type =
8969 to_fixed_range_type (name, NULL, TYPE_OBJFILE (type_arg));
8970 if (range_type == NULL)
8971 range_type = type_arg;
8972 switch (op)
8973 {
8974 default:
8975 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
8976 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
8977 return discrete_type_low_bound (range_type);
8978 case OP_ATR_LAST:
8979 return discrete_type_high_bound (range_type);
8980 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
8981 error (_("the 'length attribute applies only to array types"));
8982 }
8983 }
8984 else if (TYPE_CODE (type_arg) == TYPE_CODE_FLT)
8985 error (_("unimplemented type attribute"));
8986 else
8987 {
8988 LONGEST low, high;
8989
8990 if (ada_is_packed_array_type (type_arg))
8991 type_arg = decode_packed_array_type (type_arg);
8992
8993 if (tem < 1 || tem > ada_array_arity (type_arg))
8994 error (_("invalid dimension number to '%s"),
8995 ada_attribute_name (op));
8996
8997 type = ada_index_type (type_arg, tem);
8998 if (type == NULL)
8999 error
9000 (_("attempt to take bound of something that is not an array"));
9001 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9002 return allocate_value (type);
9003
9004 switch (op)
9005 {
9006 default:
9007 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
9008 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
9009 low = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 0, &type);
9010 return value_from_longest (type, low);
9011 case OP_ATR_LAST:
9012 high = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 1, &type);
9013 return value_from_longest (type, high);
9014 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
9015 low = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 0, &type);
9016 high = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 1, NULL);
9017 return value_from_longest (type, high - low + 1);
9018 }
9019 }
9020 }
9021
9022 case OP_ATR_TAG:
9023 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9024 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9025 goto nosideret;
9026
9027 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9028 return value_zero (ada_tag_type (arg1), not_lval);
9029
9030 return ada_value_tag (arg1);
9031
9032 case OP_ATR_MIN:
9033 case OP_ATR_MAX:
9034 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9035 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9036 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9037 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9038 goto nosideret;
9039 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9040 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
9041 else
9042 return value_binop (arg1, arg2,
9043 op == OP_ATR_MIN ? BINOP_MIN : BINOP_MAX);
9044
9045 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
9046 {
9047 struct type *type_arg = exp->elts[pc + 2].type;
9048 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9049
9050 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9051 goto nosideret;
9052
9053 if (!ada_is_modular_type (type_arg))
9054 error (_("'modulus must be applied to modular type"));
9055
9056 return value_from_longest (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type_arg),
9057 ada_modulus (type_arg));
9058 }
9059
9060
9061 case OP_ATR_POS:
9062 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9063 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9064 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9065 goto nosideret;
9066 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9067 return value_zero (builtin_type_int, not_lval);
9068 else
9069 return value_pos_atr (arg1);
9070
9071 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
9072 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9073 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9074 goto nosideret;
9075 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9076 return value_zero (builtin_type_int, not_lval);
9077 else
9078 return value_from_longest (builtin_type_int,
9079 TARGET_CHAR_BIT
9080 * TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arg1)));
9081
9082 case OP_ATR_VAL:
9083 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9084 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9085 type = exp->elts[pc + 2].type;
9086 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9087 goto nosideret;
9088 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9089 return value_zero (type, not_lval);
9090 else
9091 return value_val_atr (type, arg1);
9092
9093 case BINOP_EXP:
9094 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9095 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9096 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9097 goto nosideret;
9098 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9099 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
9100 else
9101 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
9102
9103 case UNOP_PLUS:
9104 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9105 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9106 goto nosideret;
9107 else
9108 return arg1;
9109
9110 case UNOP_ABS:
9111 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9112 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9113 goto nosideret;
9114 if (value_less (arg1, value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval)))
9115 return value_neg (arg1);
9116 else
9117 return arg1;
9118
9119 case UNOP_IND:
9120 if (expect_type && TYPE_CODE (expect_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
9121 expect_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ada_check_typedef (expect_type));
9122 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
9123 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9124 goto nosideret;
9125 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1));
9126 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9127 {
9128 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
9129 /* GDB allows dereferencing GNAT array descriptors. */
9130 {
9131 struct type *arrType = ada_type_of_array (arg1, 0);
9132 if (arrType == NULL)
9133 error (_("Attempt to dereference null array pointer."));
9134 return value_at_lazy (arrType, 0);
9135 }
9136 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
9137 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF
9138 /* In C you can dereference an array to get the 1st elt. */
9139 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
9140 {
9141 type = to_static_fixed_type
9142 (ada_aligned_type
9143 (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))));
9144 check_size (type);
9145 return value_zero (type, lval_memory);
9146 }
9147 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_INT)
9148 /* GDB allows dereferencing an int. */
9149 return value_zero (builtin_type_int, lval_memory);
9150 else
9151 error (_("Attempt to take contents of a non-pointer value."));
9152 }
9153 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1); /* FIXME: What is this for?? */
9154 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1));
9155
9156 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
9157 /* GDB allows dereferencing GNAT array descriptors. */
9158 return ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1);
9159 else
9160 return ada_value_ind (arg1);
9161
9162 case STRUCTOP_STRUCT:
9163 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
9164 (*pos) += 3 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (tem + 1);
9165 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
9166 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9167 goto nosideret;
9168 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9169 {
9170 struct type *type1 = value_type (arg1);
9171 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type1, 1))
9172 {
9173 type = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type1,
9174 &exp->elts[pc + 2].string,
9175 1, 1, NULL);
9176 if (type == NULL)
9177 /* In this case, we assume that the field COULD exist
9178 in some extension of the type. Return an object of
9179 "type" void, which will match any formal
9180 (see ada_type_match). */
9181 return value_zero (builtin_type_void, lval_memory);
9182 }
9183 else
9184 type =
9185 ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type1, &exp->elts[pc + 2].string, 1,
9186 0, NULL);
9187
9188 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
9189 }
9190 else
9191 return
9192 ada_to_fixed_value (unwrap_value
9193 (ada_value_struct_elt
9194 (arg1, &exp->elts[pc + 2].string, 0)));
9195 case OP_TYPE:
9196 /* The value is not supposed to be used. This is here to make it
9197 easier to accommodate expressions that contain types. */
9198 (*pos) += 2;
9199 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
9200 goto nosideret;
9201 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
9202 return allocate_value (exp->elts[pc + 1].type);
9203 else
9204 error (_("Attempt to use a type name as an expression"));
9205
9206 case OP_AGGREGATE:
9207 case OP_CHOICES:
9208 case OP_OTHERS:
9209 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
9210 case OP_POSITIONAL:
9211 case OP_NAME:
9212 if (noside == EVAL_NORMAL)
9213 switch (op)
9214 {
9215 case OP_NAME:
9216 error (_("Undefined name, ambiguous name, or renaming used in "
9217 "component association: %s."), &exp->elts[pc+2].string);
9218 case OP_AGGREGATE:
9219 error (_("Aggregates only allowed on the right of an assignment"));
9220 default:
9221 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("aggregate apparently mangled"));
9222 }
9223
9224 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs);
9225 *pos += oplen - 1;
9226 for (tem = 0; tem < nargs; tem += 1)
9227 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, noside);
9228 goto nosideret;
9229 }
9230
9231 nosideret:
9232 return value_from_longest (builtin_type_long, (LONGEST) 1);
9233 }
9234 \f
9235
9236 /* Fixed point */
9237
9238 /* If TYPE encodes an Ada fixed-point type, return the suffix of the
9239 type name that encodes the 'small and 'delta information.
9240 Otherwise, return NULL. */
9241
9242 static const char *
9243 fixed_type_info (struct type *type)
9244 {
9245 const char *name = ada_type_name (type);
9246 enum type_code code = (type == NULL) ? TYPE_CODE_UNDEF : TYPE_CODE (type);
9247
9248 if ((code == TYPE_CODE_INT || code == TYPE_CODE_RANGE) && name != NULL)
9249 {
9250 const char *tail = strstr (name, "___XF_");
9251 if (tail == NULL)
9252 return NULL;
9253 else
9254 return tail + 5;
9255 }
9256 else if (code == TYPE_CODE_RANGE && TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) != type)
9257 return fixed_type_info (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
9258 else
9259 return NULL;
9260 }
9261
9262 /* Returns non-zero iff TYPE represents an Ada fixed-point type. */
9263
9264 int
9265 ada_is_fixed_point_type (struct type *type)
9266 {
9267 return fixed_type_info (type) != NULL;
9268 }
9269
9270 /* Return non-zero iff TYPE represents a System.Address type. */
9271
9272 int
9273 ada_is_system_address_type (struct type *type)
9274 {
9275 return (TYPE_NAME (type)
9276 && strcmp (TYPE_NAME (type), "system__address") == 0);
9277 }
9278
9279 /* Assuming that TYPE is the representation of an Ada fixed-point
9280 type, return its delta, or -1 if the type is malformed and the
9281 delta cannot be determined. */
9282
9283 DOUBLEST
9284 ada_delta (struct type *type)
9285 {
9286 const char *encoding = fixed_type_info (type);
9287 long num, den;
9288
9289 if (sscanf (encoding, "_%ld_%ld", &num, &den) < 2)
9290 return -1.0;
9291 else
9292 return (DOUBLEST) num / (DOUBLEST) den;
9293 }
9294
9295 /* Assuming that ada_is_fixed_point_type (TYPE), return the scaling
9296 factor ('SMALL value) associated with the type. */
9297
9298 static DOUBLEST
9299 scaling_factor (struct type *type)
9300 {
9301 const char *encoding = fixed_type_info (type);
9302 unsigned long num0, den0, num1, den1;
9303 int n;
9304
9305 n = sscanf (encoding, "_%lu_%lu_%lu_%lu", &num0, &den0, &num1, &den1);
9306
9307 if (n < 2)
9308 return 1.0;
9309 else if (n == 4)
9310 return (DOUBLEST) num1 / (DOUBLEST) den1;
9311 else
9312 return (DOUBLEST) num0 / (DOUBLEST) den0;
9313 }
9314
9315
9316 /* Assuming that X is the representation of a value of fixed-point
9317 type TYPE, return its floating-point equivalent. */
9318
9319 DOUBLEST
9320 ada_fixed_to_float (struct type *type, LONGEST x)
9321 {
9322 return (DOUBLEST) x *scaling_factor (type);
9323 }
9324
9325 /* The representation of a fixed-point value of type TYPE
9326 corresponding to the value X. */
9327
9328 LONGEST
9329 ada_float_to_fixed (struct type *type, DOUBLEST x)
9330 {
9331 return (LONGEST) (x / scaling_factor (type) + 0.5);
9332 }
9333
9334
9335 /* VAX floating formats */
9336
9337 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents one of the special VAX floating-point
9338 types. */
9339
9340 int
9341 ada_is_vax_floating_type (struct type *type)
9342 {
9343 int name_len =
9344 (ada_type_name (type) == NULL) ? 0 : strlen (ada_type_name (type));
9345 return
9346 name_len > 6
9347 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_INT
9348 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
9349 && strncmp (ada_type_name (type) + name_len - 6, "___XF", 5) == 0;
9350 }
9351
9352 /* The type of special VAX floating-point type this is, assuming
9353 ada_is_vax_floating_point. */
9354
9355 int
9356 ada_vax_float_type_suffix (struct type *type)
9357 {
9358 return ada_type_name (type)[strlen (ada_type_name (type)) - 1];
9359 }
9360
9361 /* A value representing the special debugging function that outputs
9362 VAX floating-point values of the type represented by TYPE. Assumes
9363 ada_is_vax_floating_type (TYPE). */
9364
9365 struct value *
9366 ada_vax_float_print_function (struct type *type)
9367 {
9368 switch (ada_vax_float_type_suffix (type))
9369 {
9370 case 'F':
9371 return get_var_value ("DEBUG_STRING_F", 0);
9372 case 'D':
9373 return get_var_value ("DEBUG_STRING_D", 0);
9374 case 'G':
9375 return get_var_value ("DEBUG_STRING_G", 0);
9376 default:
9377 error (_("invalid VAX floating-point type"));
9378 }
9379 }
9380 \f
9381
9382 /* Range types */
9383
9384 /* Scan STR beginning at position K for a discriminant name, and
9385 return the value of that discriminant field of DVAL in *PX. If
9386 PNEW_K is not null, put the position of the character beyond the
9387 name scanned in *PNEW_K. Return 1 if successful; return 0 and do
9388 not alter *PX and *PNEW_K if unsuccessful. */
9389
9390 static int
9391 scan_discrim_bound (char *str, int k, struct value *dval, LONGEST * px,
9392 int *pnew_k)
9393 {
9394 static char *bound_buffer = NULL;
9395 static size_t bound_buffer_len = 0;
9396 char *bound;
9397 char *pend;
9398 struct value *bound_val;
9399
9400 if (dval == NULL || str == NULL || str[k] == '\0')
9401 return 0;
9402
9403 pend = strstr (str + k, "__");
9404 if (pend == NULL)
9405 {
9406 bound = str + k;
9407 k += strlen (bound);
9408 }
9409 else
9410 {
9411 GROW_VECT (bound_buffer, bound_buffer_len, pend - (str + k) + 1);
9412 bound = bound_buffer;
9413 strncpy (bound_buffer, str + k, pend - (str + k));
9414 bound[pend - (str + k)] = '\0';
9415 k = pend - str;
9416 }
9417
9418 bound_val = ada_search_struct_field (bound, dval, 0, value_type (dval));
9419 if (bound_val == NULL)
9420 return 0;
9421
9422 *px = value_as_long (bound_val);
9423 if (pnew_k != NULL)
9424 *pnew_k = k;
9425 return 1;
9426 }
9427
9428 /* Value of variable named NAME in the current environment. If
9429 no such variable found, then if ERR_MSG is null, returns 0, and
9430 otherwise causes an error with message ERR_MSG. */
9431
9432 static struct value *
9433 get_var_value (char *name, char *err_msg)
9434 {
9435 struct ada_symbol_info *syms;
9436 int nsyms;
9437
9438 nsyms = ada_lookup_symbol_list (name, get_selected_block (0), VAR_DOMAIN,
9439 &syms);
9440
9441 if (nsyms != 1)
9442 {
9443 if (err_msg == NULL)
9444 return 0;
9445 else
9446 error (("%s"), err_msg);
9447 }
9448
9449 return value_of_variable (syms[0].sym, syms[0].block);
9450 }
9451
9452 /* Value of integer variable named NAME in the current environment. If
9453 no such variable found, returns 0, and sets *FLAG to 0. If
9454 successful, sets *FLAG to 1. */
9455
9456 LONGEST
9457 get_int_var_value (char *name, int *flag)
9458 {
9459 struct value *var_val = get_var_value (name, 0);
9460
9461 if (var_val == 0)
9462 {
9463 if (flag != NULL)
9464 *flag = 0;
9465 return 0;
9466 }
9467 else
9468 {
9469 if (flag != NULL)
9470 *flag = 1;
9471 return value_as_long (var_val);
9472 }
9473 }
9474
9475
9476 /* Return a range type whose base type is that of the range type named
9477 NAME in the current environment, and whose bounds are calculated
9478 from NAME according to the GNAT range encoding conventions.
9479 Extract discriminant values, if needed, from DVAL. If a new type
9480 must be created, allocate in OBJFILE's space. The bounds
9481 information, in general, is encoded in NAME, the base type given in
9482 the named range type. */
9483
9484 static struct type *
9485 to_fixed_range_type (char *name, struct value *dval, struct objfile *objfile)
9486 {
9487 struct type *raw_type = ada_find_any_type (name);
9488 struct type *base_type;
9489 char *subtype_info;
9490
9491 if (raw_type == NULL)
9492 base_type = builtin_type_int;
9493 else if (TYPE_CODE (raw_type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
9494 base_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (raw_type);
9495 else
9496 base_type = raw_type;
9497
9498 subtype_info = strstr (name, "___XD");
9499 if (subtype_info == NULL)
9500 return raw_type;
9501 else
9502 {
9503 static char *name_buf = NULL;
9504 static size_t name_len = 0;
9505 int prefix_len = subtype_info - name;
9506 LONGEST L, U;
9507 struct type *type;
9508 char *bounds_str;
9509 int n;
9510
9511 GROW_VECT (name_buf, name_len, prefix_len + 5);
9512 strncpy (name_buf, name, prefix_len);
9513 name_buf[prefix_len] = '\0';
9514
9515 subtype_info += 5;
9516 bounds_str = strchr (subtype_info, '_');
9517 n = 1;
9518
9519 if (*subtype_info == 'L')
9520 {
9521 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &L, &n)
9522 && !scan_discrim_bound (bounds_str, n, dval, &L, &n))
9523 return raw_type;
9524 if (bounds_str[n] == '_')
9525 n += 2;
9526 else if (bounds_str[n] == '.') /* FIXME? SGI Workshop kludge. */
9527 n += 1;
9528 subtype_info += 1;
9529 }
9530 else
9531 {
9532 int ok;
9533 strcpy (name_buf + prefix_len, "___L");
9534 L = get_int_var_value (name_buf, &ok);
9535 if (!ok)
9536 {
9537 lim_warning (_("Unknown lower bound, using 1."));
9538 L = 1;
9539 }
9540 }
9541
9542 if (*subtype_info == 'U')
9543 {
9544 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &U, &n)
9545 && !scan_discrim_bound (bounds_str, n, dval, &U, &n))
9546 return raw_type;
9547 }
9548 else
9549 {
9550 int ok;
9551 strcpy (name_buf + prefix_len, "___U");
9552 U = get_int_var_value (name_buf, &ok);
9553 if (!ok)
9554 {
9555 lim_warning (_("Unknown upper bound, using %ld."), (long) L);
9556 U = L;
9557 }
9558 }
9559
9560 if (objfile == NULL)
9561 objfile = TYPE_OBJFILE (base_type);
9562 type = create_range_type (alloc_type (objfile), base_type, L, U);
9563 TYPE_NAME (type) = name;
9564 return type;
9565 }
9566 }
9567
9568 /* True iff NAME is the name of a range type. */
9569
9570 int
9571 ada_is_range_type_name (const char *name)
9572 {
9573 return (name != NULL && strstr (name, "___XD"));
9574 }
9575 \f
9576
9577 /* Modular types */
9578
9579 /* True iff TYPE is an Ada modular type. */
9580
9581 int
9582 ada_is_modular_type (struct type *type)
9583 {
9584 struct type *subranged_type = base_type (type);
9585
9586 return (subranged_type != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE
9587 && TYPE_CODE (subranged_type) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM
9588 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (subranged_type));
9589 }
9590
9591 /* Assuming ada_is_modular_type (TYPE), the modulus of TYPE. */
9592
9593 ULONGEST
9594 ada_modulus (struct type * type)
9595 {
9596 return (ULONGEST) TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type) + 1;
9597 }
9598 \f
9599
9600 /* Ada exception catchpoint support:
9601 ---------------------------------
9602
9603 We support 3 kinds of exception catchpoints:
9604 . catchpoints on Ada exceptions
9605 . catchpoints on unhandled Ada exceptions
9606 . catchpoints on failed assertions
9607
9608 Exceptions raised during failed assertions, or unhandled exceptions
9609 could perfectly be caught with the general catchpoint on Ada exceptions.
9610 However, we can easily differentiate these two special cases, and having
9611 the option to distinguish these two cases from the rest can be useful
9612 to zero-in on certain situations.
9613
9614 Exception catchpoints are a specialized form of breakpoint,
9615 since they rely on inserting breakpoints inside known routines
9616 of the GNAT runtime. The implementation therefore uses a standard
9617 breakpoint structure of the BP_BREAKPOINT type, but with its own set
9618 of breakpoint_ops.
9619
9620 Support in the runtime for exception catchpoints have been changed
9621 a few times already, and these changes affect the implementation
9622 of these catchpoints. In order to be able to support several
9623 variants of the runtime, we use a sniffer that will determine
9624 the runtime variant used by the program being debugged.
9625
9626 At this time, we do not support the use of conditions on Ada exception
9627 catchpoints. The COND and COND_STRING fields are therefore set
9628 to NULL (most of the time, see below).
9629
9630 Conditions where EXP_STRING, COND, and COND_STRING are used:
9631
9632 When a user specifies the name of a specific exception in the case
9633 of catchpoints on Ada exceptions, we store the name of that exception
9634 in the EXP_STRING. We then translate this request into an actual
9635 condition stored in COND_STRING, and then parse it into an expression
9636 stored in COND. */
9637
9638 /* The different types of catchpoints that we introduced for catching
9639 Ada exceptions. */
9640
9641 enum exception_catchpoint_kind
9642 {
9643 ex_catch_exception,
9644 ex_catch_exception_unhandled,
9645 ex_catch_assert
9646 };
9647
9648 typedef CORE_ADDR (ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_ftype) (void);
9649
9650 /* A structure that describes how to support exception catchpoints
9651 for a given executable. */
9652
9653 struct exception_support_info
9654 {
9655 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
9656 a catchpoint on exceptions. */
9657 const char *catch_exception_sym;
9658
9659 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
9660 a catchpoint on unhandled exceptions. */
9661 const char *catch_exception_unhandled_sym;
9662
9663 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
9664 a catchpoint on failed assertions. */
9665 const char *catch_assert_sym;
9666
9667 /* Assuming that the inferior just triggered an unhandled exception
9668 catchpoint, this function is responsible for returning the address
9669 in inferior memory where the name of that exception is stored.
9670 Return zero if the address could not be computed. */
9671 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_ftype *unhandled_exception_name_addr;
9672 };
9673
9674 static CORE_ADDR ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr (void);
9675 static CORE_ADDR ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise (void);
9676
9677 /* The following exception support info structure describes how to
9678 implement exception catchpoints with the latest version of the
9679 Ada runtime (as of 2007-03-06). */
9680
9681 static const struct exception_support_info default_exception_support_info =
9682 {
9683 "__gnat_debug_raise_exception", /* catch_exception_sym */
9684 "__gnat_unhandled_exception", /* catch_exception_unhandled_sym */
9685 "__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure", /* catch_assert_sym */
9686 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr
9687 };
9688
9689 /* The following exception support info structure describes how to
9690 implement exception catchpoints with a slightly older version
9691 of the Ada runtime. */
9692
9693 static const struct exception_support_info exception_support_info_fallback =
9694 {
9695 "__gnat_raise_nodefer_with_msg", /* catch_exception_sym */
9696 "__gnat_unhandled_exception", /* catch_exception_unhandled_sym */
9697 "system__assertions__raise_assert_failure", /* catch_assert_sym */
9698 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise
9699 };
9700
9701 /* For each executable, we sniff which exception info structure to use
9702 and cache it in the following global variable. */
9703
9704 static const struct exception_support_info *exception_info = NULL;
9705
9706 /* Inspect the Ada runtime and determine which exception info structure
9707 should be used to provide support for exception catchpoints.
9708
9709 This function will always set exception_info, or raise an error. */
9710
9711 static void
9712 ada_exception_support_info_sniffer (void)
9713 {
9714 struct symbol *sym;
9715
9716 /* If the exception info is already known, then no need to recompute it. */
9717 if (exception_info != NULL)
9718 return;
9719
9720 /* Check the latest (default) exception support info. */
9721 sym = standard_lookup (default_exception_support_info.catch_exception_sym,
9722 NULL, VAR_DOMAIN);
9723 if (sym != NULL)
9724 {
9725 exception_info = &default_exception_support_info;
9726 return;
9727 }
9728
9729 /* Try our fallback exception suport info. */
9730 sym = standard_lookup (exception_support_info_fallback.catch_exception_sym,
9731 NULL, VAR_DOMAIN);
9732 if (sym != NULL)
9733 {
9734 exception_info = &exception_support_info_fallback;
9735 return;
9736 }
9737
9738 /* Sometimes, it is normal for us to not be able to find the routine
9739 we are looking for. This happens when the program is linked with
9740 the shared version of the GNAT runtime, and the program has not been
9741 started yet. Inform the user of these two possible causes if
9742 applicable. */
9743
9744 if (ada_update_initial_language (language_unknown, NULL) != language_ada)
9745 error (_("Unable to insert catchpoint. Is this an Ada main program?"));
9746
9747 /* If the symbol does not exist, then check that the program is
9748 already started, to make sure that shared libraries have been
9749 loaded. If it is not started, this may mean that the symbol is
9750 in a shared library. */
9751
9752 if (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid) == 0)
9753 error (_("Unable to insert catchpoint. Try to start the program first."));
9754
9755 /* At this point, we know that we are debugging an Ada program and
9756 that the inferior has been started, but we still are not able to
9757 find the run-time symbols. That can mean that we are in
9758 configurable run time mode, or that a-except as been optimized
9759 out by the linker... In any case, at this point it is not worth
9760 supporting this feature. */
9761
9762 error (_("Cannot insert catchpoints in this configuration."));
9763 }
9764
9765 /* An observer of "executable_changed" events.
9766 Its role is to clear certain cached values that need to be recomputed
9767 each time a new executable is loaded by GDB. */
9768
9769 static void
9770 ada_executable_changed_observer (void *unused)
9771 {
9772 /* If the executable changed, then it is possible that the Ada runtime
9773 is different. So we need to invalidate the exception support info
9774 cache. */
9775 exception_info = NULL;
9776 }
9777
9778 /* Return the name of the function at PC, NULL if could not find it.
9779 This function only checks the debugging information, not the symbol
9780 table. */
9781
9782 static char *
9783 function_name_from_pc (CORE_ADDR pc)
9784 {
9785 char *func_name;
9786
9787 if (!find_pc_partial_function (pc, &func_name, NULL, NULL))
9788 return NULL;
9789
9790 return func_name;
9791 }
9792
9793 /* True iff FRAME is very likely to be that of a function that is
9794 part of the runtime system. This is all very heuristic, but is
9795 intended to be used as advice as to what frames are uninteresting
9796 to most users. */
9797
9798 static int
9799 is_known_support_routine (struct frame_info *frame)
9800 {
9801 struct symtab_and_line sal;
9802 char *func_name;
9803 int i;
9804
9805 /* If this code does not have any debugging information (no symtab),
9806 This cannot be any user code. */
9807
9808 find_frame_sal (frame, &sal);
9809 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
9810 return 1;
9811
9812 /* If there is a symtab, but the associated source file cannot be
9813 located, then assume this is not user code: Selecting a frame
9814 for which we cannot display the code would not be very helpful
9815 for the user. This should also take care of case such as VxWorks
9816 where the kernel has some debugging info provided for a few units. */
9817
9818 if (symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab) == NULL)
9819 return 1;
9820
9821 /* Check the unit filename againt the Ada runtime file naming.
9822 We also check the name of the objfile against the name of some
9823 known system libraries that sometimes come with debugging info
9824 too. */
9825
9826 for (i = 0; known_runtime_file_name_patterns[i] != NULL; i += 1)
9827 {
9828 re_comp (known_runtime_file_name_patterns[i]);
9829 if (re_exec (sal.symtab->filename))
9830 return 1;
9831 if (sal.symtab->objfile != NULL
9832 && re_exec (sal.symtab->objfile->name))
9833 return 1;
9834 }
9835
9836 /* Check whether the function is a GNAT-generated entity. */
9837
9838 func_name = function_name_from_pc (get_frame_address_in_block (frame));
9839 if (func_name == NULL)
9840 return 1;
9841
9842 for (i = 0; known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[i] != NULL; i += 1)
9843 {
9844 re_comp (known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[i]);
9845 if (re_exec (func_name))
9846 return 1;
9847 }
9848
9849 return 0;
9850 }
9851
9852 /* Find the first frame that contains debugging information and that is not
9853 part of the Ada run-time, starting from FI and moving upward. */
9854
9855 static void
9856 ada_find_printable_frame (struct frame_info *fi)
9857 {
9858 for (; fi != NULL; fi = get_prev_frame (fi))
9859 {
9860 if (!is_known_support_routine (fi))
9861 {
9862 select_frame (fi);
9863 break;
9864 }
9865 }
9866
9867 }
9868
9869 /* Assuming that the inferior just triggered an unhandled exception
9870 catchpoint, return the address in inferior memory where the name
9871 of the exception is stored.
9872
9873 Return zero if the address could not be computed. */
9874
9875 static CORE_ADDR
9876 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr (void)
9877 {
9878 return parse_and_eval_address ("e.full_name");
9879 }
9880
9881 /* Same as ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr, except that this function
9882 should be used when the inferior uses an older version of the runtime,
9883 where the exception name needs to be extracted from a specific frame
9884 several frames up in the callstack. */
9885
9886 static CORE_ADDR
9887 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise (void)
9888 {
9889 int frame_level;
9890 struct frame_info *fi;
9891
9892 /* To determine the name of this exception, we need to select
9893 the frame corresponding to RAISE_SYM_NAME. This frame is
9894 at least 3 levels up, so we simply skip the first 3 frames
9895 without checking the name of their associated function. */
9896 fi = get_current_frame ();
9897 for (frame_level = 0; frame_level < 3; frame_level += 1)
9898 if (fi != NULL)
9899 fi = get_prev_frame (fi);
9900
9901 while (fi != NULL)
9902 {
9903 const char *func_name =
9904 function_name_from_pc (get_frame_address_in_block (fi));
9905 if (func_name != NULL
9906 && strcmp (func_name, exception_info->catch_exception_sym) == 0)
9907 break; /* We found the frame we were looking for... */
9908 fi = get_prev_frame (fi);
9909 }
9910
9911 if (fi == NULL)
9912 return 0;
9913
9914 select_frame (fi);
9915 return parse_and_eval_address ("id.full_name");
9916 }
9917
9918 /* Assuming the inferior just triggered an Ada exception catchpoint
9919 (of any type), return the address in inferior memory where the name
9920 of the exception is stored, if applicable.
9921
9922 Return zero if the address could not be computed, or if not relevant. */
9923
9924 static CORE_ADDR
9925 ada_exception_name_addr_1 (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
9926 struct breakpoint *b)
9927 {
9928 switch (ex)
9929 {
9930 case ex_catch_exception:
9931 return (parse_and_eval_address ("e.full_name"));
9932 break;
9933
9934 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
9935 return exception_info->unhandled_exception_name_addr ();
9936 break;
9937
9938 case ex_catch_assert:
9939 return 0; /* Exception name is not relevant in this case. */
9940 break;
9941
9942 default:
9943 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
9944 break;
9945 }
9946
9947 return 0; /* Should never be reached. */
9948 }
9949
9950 /* Same as ada_exception_name_addr_1, except that it intercepts and contains
9951 any error that ada_exception_name_addr_1 might cause to be thrown.
9952 When an error is intercepted, a warning with the error message is printed,
9953 and zero is returned. */
9954
9955 static CORE_ADDR
9956 ada_exception_name_addr (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
9957 struct breakpoint *b)
9958 {
9959 struct gdb_exception e;
9960 CORE_ADDR result = 0;
9961
9962 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
9963 {
9964 result = ada_exception_name_addr_1 (ex, b);
9965 }
9966
9967 if (e.reason < 0)
9968 {
9969 warning (_("failed to get exception name: %s"), e.message);
9970 return 0;
9971 }
9972
9973 return result;
9974 }
9975
9976 /* Implement the PRINT_IT method in the breakpoint_ops structure
9977 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
9978
9979 static enum print_stop_action
9980 print_it_exception (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex, struct breakpoint *b)
9981 {
9982 const CORE_ADDR addr = ada_exception_name_addr (ex, b);
9983 char exception_name[256];
9984
9985 if (addr != 0)
9986 {
9987 read_memory (addr, exception_name, sizeof (exception_name) - 1);
9988 exception_name [sizeof (exception_name) - 1] = '\0';
9989 }
9990
9991 ada_find_printable_frame (get_current_frame ());
9992
9993 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
9994 switch (ex)
9995 {
9996 case ex_catch_exception:
9997 if (addr != 0)
9998 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d, %s at "),
9999 b->number, exception_name);
10000 else
10001 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d, exception at "), b->number);
10002 break;
10003 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
10004 if (addr != 0)
10005 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d, unhandled %s at "),
10006 b->number, exception_name);
10007 else
10008 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d, unhandled exception at "),
10009 b->number);
10010 break;
10011 case ex_catch_assert:
10012 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d, failed assertion at "),
10013 b->number);
10014 break;
10015 }
10016
10017 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
10018 }
10019
10020 /* Implement the PRINT_ONE method in the breakpoint_ops structure
10021 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
10022
10023 static void
10024 print_one_exception (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
10025 struct breakpoint *b, CORE_ADDR *last_addr)
10026 {
10027 if (addressprint)
10028 {
10029 annotate_field (4);
10030 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr", b->loc->address);
10031 }
10032
10033 annotate_field (5);
10034 *last_addr = b->loc->address;
10035 switch (ex)
10036 {
10037 case ex_catch_exception:
10038 if (b->exp_string != NULL)
10039 {
10040 char *msg = xstrprintf (_("`%s' Ada exception"), b->exp_string);
10041
10042 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", msg);
10043 xfree (msg);
10044 }
10045 else
10046 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "all Ada exceptions");
10047
10048 break;
10049
10050 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
10051 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "unhandled Ada exceptions");
10052 break;
10053
10054 case ex_catch_assert:
10055 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "failed Ada assertions");
10056 break;
10057
10058 default:
10059 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
10060 break;
10061 }
10062 }
10063
10064 /* Implement the PRINT_MENTION method in the breakpoint_ops structure
10065 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
10066
10067 static void
10068 print_mention_exception (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
10069 struct breakpoint *b)
10070 {
10071 switch (ex)
10072 {
10073 case ex_catch_exception:
10074 if (b->exp_string != NULL)
10075 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d: `%s' Ada exception"),
10076 b->number, b->exp_string);
10077 else
10078 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d: all Ada exceptions"), b->number);
10079
10080 break;
10081
10082 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
10083 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d: unhandled Ada exceptions"),
10084 b->number);
10085 break;
10086
10087 case ex_catch_assert:
10088 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d: failed Ada assertions"), b->number);
10089 break;
10090
10091 default:
10092 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
10093 break;
10094 }
10095 }
10096
10097 /* Virtual table for "catch exception" breakpoints. */
10098
10099 static enum print_stop_action
10100 print_it_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b)
10101 {
10102 return print_it_exception (ex_catch_exception, b);
10103 }
10104
10105 static void
10106 print_one_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b, CORE_ADDR *last_addr)
10107 {
10108 print_one_exception (ex_catch_exception, b, last_addr);
10109 }
10110
10111 static void
10112 print_mention_catch_exception (struct breakpoint *b)
10113 {
10114 print_mention_exception (ex_catch_exception, b);
10115 }
10116
10117 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exception_breakpoint_ops =
10118 {
10119 print_it_catch_exception,
10120 print_one_catch_exception,
10121 print_mention_catch_exception
10122 };
10123
10124 /* Virtual table for "catch exception unhandled" breakpoints. */
10125
10126 static enum print_stop_action
10127 print_it_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b)
10128 {
10129 return print_it_exception (ex_catch_exception_unhandled, b);
10130 }
10131
10132 static void
10133 print_one_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b, CORE_ADDR *last_addr)
10134 {
10135 print_one_exception (ex_catch_exception_unhandled, b, last_addr);
10136 }
10137
10138 static void
10139 print_mention_catch_exception_unhandled (struct breakpoint *b)
10140 {
10141 print_mention_exception (ex_catch_exception_unhandled, b);
10142 }
10143
10144 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops = {
10145 print_it_catch_exception_unhandled,
10146 print_one_catch_exception_unhandled,
10147 print_mention_catch_exception_unhandled
10148 };
10149
10150 /* Virtual table for "catch assert" breakpoints. */
10151
10152 static enum print_stop_action
10153 print_it_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b)
10154 {
10155 return print_it_exception (ex_catch_assert, b);
10156 }
10157
10158 static void
10159 print_one_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b, CORE_ADDR *last_addr)
10160 {
10161 print_one_exception (ex_catch_assert, b, last_addr);
10162 }
10163
10164 static void
10165 print_mention_catch_assert (struct breakpoint *b)
10166 {
10167 print_mention_exception (ex_catch_assert, b);
10168 }
10169
10170 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_assert_breakpoint_ops = {
10171 print_it_catch_assert,
10172 print_one_catch_assert,
10173 print_mention_catch_assert
10174 };
10175
10176 /* Return non-zero if B is an Ada exception catchpoint. */
10177
10178 int
10179 ada_exception_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
10180 {
10181 return (b->ops == &catch_exception_breakpoint_ops
10182 || b->ops == &catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops
10183 || b->ops == &catch_assert_breakpoint_ops);
10184 }
10185
10186 /* Return a newly allocated copy of the first space-separated token
10187 in ARGSP, and then adjust ARGSP to point immediately after that
10188 token.
10189
10190 Return NULL if ARGPS does not contain any more tokens. */
10191
10192 static char *
10193 ada_get_next_arg (char **argsp)
10194 {
10195 char *args = *argsp;
10196 char *end;
10197 char *result;
10198
10199 /* Skip any leading white space. */
10200
10201 while (isspace (*args))
10202 args++;
10203
10204 if (args[0] == '\0')
10205 return NULL; /* No more arguments. */
10206
10207 /* Find the end of the current argument. */
10208
10209 end = args;
10210 while (*end != '\0' && !isspace (*end))
10211 end++;
10212
10213 /* Adjust ARGSP to point to the start of the next argument. */
10214
10215 *argsp = end;
10216
10217 /* Make a copy of the current argument and return it. */
10218
10219 result = xmalloc (end - args + 1);
10220 strncpy (result, args, end - args);
10221 result[end - args] = '\0';
10222
10223 return result;
10224 }
10225
10226 /* Split the arguments specified in a "catch exception" command.
10227 Set EX to the appropriate catchpoint type.
10228 Set EXP_STRING to the name of the specific exception if
10229 specified by the user. */
10230
10231 static void
10232 catch_ada_exception_command_split (char *args,
10233 enum exception_catchpoint_kind *ex,
10234 char **exp_string)
10235 {
10236 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
10237 char *exception_name;
10238
10239 exception_name = ada_get_next_arg (&args);
10240 make_cleanup (xfree, exception_name);
10241
10242 /* Check that we do not have any more arguments. Anything else
10243 is unexpected. */
10244
10245 while (isspace (*args))
10246 args++;
10247
10248 if (args[0] != '\0')
10249 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
10250
10251 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
10252
10253 if (exception_name == NULL)
10254 {
10255 /* Catch all exceptions. */
10256 *ex = ex_catch_exception;
10257 *exp_string = NULL;
10258 }
10259 else if (strcmp (exception_name, "unhandled") == 0)
10260 {
10261 /* Catch unhandled exceptions. */
10262 *ex = ex_catch_exception_unhandled;
10263 *exp_string = NULL;
10264 }
10265 else
10266 {
10267 /* Catch a specific exception. */
10268 *ex = ex_catch_exception;
10269 *exp_string = exception_name;
10270 }
10271 }
10272
10273 /* Return the name of the symbol on which we should break in order to
10274 implement a catchpoint of the EX kind. */
10275
10276 static const char *
10277 ada_exception_sym_name (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex)
10278 {
10279 gdb_assert (exception_info != NULL);
10280
10281 switch (ex)
10282 {
10283 case ex_catch_exception:
10284 return (exception_info->catch_exception_sym);
10285 break;
10286 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
10287 return (exception_info->catch_exception_unhandled_sym);
10288 break;
10289 case ex_catch_assert:
10290 return (exception_info->catch_assert_sym);
10291 break;
10292 default:
10293 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10294 _("unexpected catchpoint kind (%d)"), ex);
10295 }
10296 }
10297
10298 /* Return the breakpoint ops "virtual table" used for catchpoints
10299 of the EX kind. */
10300
10301 static struct breakpoint_ops *
10302 ada_exception_breakpoint_ops (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex)
10303 {
10304 switch (ex)
10305 {
10306 case ex_catch_exception:
10307 return (&catch_exception_breakpoint_ops);
10308 break;
10309 case ex_catch_exception_unhandled:
10310 return (&catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops);
10311 break;
10312 case ex_catch_assert:
10313 return (&catch_assert_breakpoint_ops);
10314 break;
10315 default:
10316 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10317 _("unexpected catchpoint kind (%d)"), ex);
10318 }
10319 }
10320
10321 /* Return the condition that will be used to match the current exception
10322 being raised with the exception that the user wants to catch. This
10323 assumes that this condition is used when the inferior just triggered
10324 an exception catchpoint.
10325
10326 The string returned is a newly allocated string that needs to be
10327 deallocated later. */
10328
10329 static char *
10330 ada_exception_catchpoint_cond_string (const char *exp_string)
10331 {
10332 return xstrprintf ("long_integer (e) = long_integer (&%s)", exp_string);
10333 }
10334
10335 /* Return the expression corresponding to COND_STRING evaluated at SAL. */
10336
10337 static struct expression *
10338 ada_parse_catchpoint_condition (char *cond_string,
10339 struct symtab_and_line sal)
10340 {
10341 return (parse_exp_1 (&cond_string, block_for_pc (sal.pc), 0));
10342 }
10343
10344 /* Return the symtab_and_line that should be used to insert an exception
10345 catchpoint of the TYPE kind.
10346
10347 EX_STRING should contain the name of a specific exception
10348 that the catchpoint should catch, or NULL otherwise.
10349
10350 The idea behind all the remaining parameters is that their names match
10351 the name of certain fields in the breakpoint structure that are used to
10352 handle exception catchpoints. This function returns the value to which
10353 these fields should be set, depending on the type of catchpoint we need
10354 to create.
10355
10356 If COND and COND_STRING are both non-NULL, any value they might
10357 hold will be free'ed, and then replaced by newly allocated ones.
10358 These parameters are left untouched otherwise. */
10359
10360 static struct symtab_and_line
10361 ada_exception_sal (enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex, char *exp_string,
10362 char **addr_string, char **cond_string,
10363 struct expression **cond, struct breakpoint_ops **ops)
10364 {
10365 const char *sym_name;
10366 struct symbol *sym;
10367 struct symtab_and_line sal;
10368
10369 /* First, find out which exception support info to use. */
10370 ada_exception_support_info_sniffer ();
10371
10372 /* Then lookup the function on which we will break in order to catch
10373 the Ada exceptions requested by the user. */
10374
10375 sym_name = ada_exception_sym_name (ex);
10376 sym = standard_lookup (sym_name, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN);
10377
10378 /* The symbol we're looking up is provided by a unit in the GNAT runtime
10379 that should be compiled with debugging information. As a result, we
10380 expect to find that symbol in the symtabs. If we don't find it, then
10381 the target most likely does not support Ada exceptions, or we cannot
10382 insert exception breakpoints yet, because the GNAT runtime hasn't been
10383 loaded yet. */
10384
10385 /* brobecker/2006-12-26: It is conceivable that the runtime was compiled
10386 in such a way that no debugging information is produced for the symbol
10387 we are looking for. In this case, we could search the minimal symbols
10388 as a fall-back mechanism. This would still be operating in degraded
10389 mode, however, as we would still be missing the debugging information
10390 that is needed in order to extract the name of the exception being
10391 raised (this name is printed in the catchpoint message, and is also
10392 used when trying to catch a specific exception). We do not handle
10393 this case for now. */
10394
10395 if (sym == NULL)
10396 error (_("Unable to break on '%s' in this configuration."), sym_name);
10397
10398 /* Make sure that the symbol we found corresponds to a function. */
10399 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_BLOCK)
10400 error (_("Symbol \"%s\" is not a function (class = %d)"),
10401 sym_name, SYMBOL_CLASS (sym));
10402
10403 sal = find_function_start_sal (sym, 1);
10404
10405 /* Set ADDR_STRING. */
10406
10407 *addr_string = xstrdup (sym_name);
10408
10409 /* Set the COND and COND_STRING (if not NULL). */
10410
10411 if (cond_string != NULL && cond != NULL)
10412 {
10413 if (*cond_string != NULL)
10414 {
10415 xfree (*cond_string);
10416 *cond_string = NULL;
10417 }
10418 if (*cond != NULL)
10419 {
10420 xfree (*cond);
10421 *cond = NULL;
10422 }
10423 if (exp_string != NULL)
10424 {
10425 *cond_string = ada_exception_catchpoint_cond_string (exp_string);
10426 *cond = ada_parse_catchpoint_condition (*cond_string, sal);
10427 }
10428 }
10429
10430 /* Set OPS. */
10431 *ops = ada_exception_breakpoint_ops (ex);
10432
10433 return sal;
10434 }
10435
10436 /* Parse the arguments (ARGS) of the "catch exception" command.
10437
10438 Set TYPE to the appropriate exception catchpoint type.
10439 If the user asked the catchpoint to catch only a specific
10440 exception, then save the exception name in ADDR_STRING.
10441
10442 See ada_exception_sal for a description of all the remaining
10443 function arguments of this function. */
10444
10445 struct symtab_and_line
10446 ada_decode_exception_location (char *args, char **addr_string,
10447 char **exp_string, char **cond_string,
10448 struct expression **cond,
10449 struct breakpoint_ops **ops)
10450 {
10451 enum exception_catchpoint_kind ex;
10452
10453 catch_ada_exception_command_split (args, &ex, exp_string);
10454 return ada_exception_sal (ex, *exp_string, addr_string, cond_string,
10455 cond, ops);
10456 }
10457
10458 struct symtab_and_line
10459 ada_decode_assert_location (char *args, char **addr_string,
10460 struct breakpoint_ops **ops)
10461 {
10462 /* Check that no argument where provided at the end of the command. */
10463
10464 if (args != NULL)
10465 {
10466 while (isspace (*args))
10467 args++;
10468 if (*args != '\0')
10469 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
10470 }
10471
10472 return ada_exception_sal (ex_catch_assert, NULL, addr_string, NULL, NULL,
10473 ops);
10474 }
10475
10476 /* Operators */
10477 /* Information about operators given special treatment in functions
10478 below. */
10479 /* Format: OP_DEFN (<operator>, <operator length>, <# args>, <binop>). */
10480
10481 #define ADA_OPERATORS \
10482 OP_DEFN (OP_VAR_VALUE, 4, 0, 0) \
10483 OP_DEFN (BINOP_IN_BOUNDS, 3, 2, 0) \
10484 OP_DEFN (TERNOP_IN_RANGE, 1, 3, 0) \
10485 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_FIRST, 1, 2, 0) \
10486 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_LAST, 1, 2, 0) \
10487 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_LENGTH, 1, 2, 0) \
10488 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_IMAGE, 1, 2, 0) \
10489 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MAX, 1, 3, 0) \
10490 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MIN, 1, 3, 0) \
10491 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MODULUS, 1, 1, 0) \
10492 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_POS, 1, 2, 0) \
10493 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_SIZE, 1, 1, 0) \
10494 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_TAG, 1, 1, 0) \
10495 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_VAL, 1, 2, 0) \
10496 OP_DEFN (UNOP_QUAL, 3, 1, 0) \
10497 OP_DEFN (UNOP_IN_RANGE, 3, 1, 0) \
10498 OP_DEFN (OP_OTHERS, 1, 1, 0) \
10499 OP_DEFN (OP_POSITIONAL, 3, 1, 0) \
10500 OP_DEFN (OP_DISCRETE_RANGE, 1, 2, 0)
10501
10502 static void
10503 ada_operator_length (struct expression *exp, int pc, int *oplenp, int *argsp)
10504 {
10505 switch (exp->elts[pc - 1].opcode)
10506 {
10507 default:
10508 operator_length_standard (exp, pc, oplenp, argsp);
10509 break;
10510
10511 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) \
10512 case op: *oplenp = len; *argsp = args; break;
10513 ADA_OPERATORS;
10514 #undef OP_DEFN
10515
10516 case OP_AGGREGATE:
10517 *oplenp = 3;
10518 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc - 2].longconst);
10519 break;
10520
10521 case OP_CHOICES:
10522 *oplenp = 3;
10523 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc - 2].longconst) + 1;
10524 break;
10525 }
10526 }
10527
10528 static char *
10529 ada_op_name (enum exp_opcode opcode)
10530 {
10531 switch (opcode)
10532 {
10533 default:
10534 return op_name_standard (opcode);
10535
10536 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) case op: return #op;
10537 ADA_OPERATORS;
10538 #undef OP_DEFN
10539
10540 case OP_AGGREGATE:
10541 return "OP_AGGREGATE";
10542 case OP_CHOICES:
10543 return "OP_CHOICES";
10544 case OP_NAME:
10545 return "OP_NAME";
10546 }
10547 }
10548
10549 /* As for operator_length, but assumes PC is pointing at the first
10550 element of the operator, and gives meaningful results only for the
10551 Ada-specific operators, returning 0 for *OPLENP and *ARGSP otherwise. */
10552
10553 static void
10554 ada_forward_operator_length (struct expression *exp, int pc,
10555 int *oplenp, int *argsp)
10556 {
10557 switch (exp->elts[pc].opcode)
10558 {
10559 default:
10560 *oplenp = *argsp = 0;
10561 break;
10562
10563 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) \
10564 case op: *oplenp = len; *argsp = args; break;
10565 ADA_OPERATORS;
10566 #undef OP_DEFN
10567
10568 case OP_AGGREGATE:
10569 *oplenp = 3;
10570 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
10571 break;
10572
10573 case OP_CHOICES:
10574 *oplenp = 3;
10575 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst) + 1;
10576 break;
10577
10578 case OP_STRING:
10579 case OP_NAME:
10580 {
10581 int len = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
10582 *oplenp = 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (len + 1);
10583 *argsp = 0;
10584 break;
10585 }
10586 }
10587 }
10588
10589 static int
10590 ada_dump_subexp_body (struct expression *exp, struct ui_file *stream, int elt)
10591 {
10592 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[elt].opcode;
10593 int oplen, nargs;
10594 int pc = elt;
10595 int i;
10596
10597 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, elt, &oplen, &nargs);
10598
10599 switch (op)
10600 {
10601 /* Ada attributes ('Foo). */
10602 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
10603 case OP_ATR_LAST:
10604 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
10605 case OP_ATR_IMAGE:
10606 case OP_ATR_MAX:
10607 case OP_ATR_MIN:
10608 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
10609 case OP_ATR_POS:
10610 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
10611 case OP_ATR_TAG:
10612 case OP_ATR_VAL:
10613 break;
10614
10615 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
10616 case UNOP_QUAL:
10617 /* XXX: gdb_sprint_host_address, type_sprint */
10618 fprintf_filtered (stream, _("Type @"));
10619 gdb_print_host_address (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, stream);
10620 fprintf_filtered (stream, " (");
10621 type_print (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, NULL, stream, 0);
10622 fprintf_filtered (stream, ")");
10623 break;
10624 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
10625 fprintf_filtered (stream, " (%d)",
10626 longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 2].longconst));
10627 break;
10628 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
10629 break;
10630
10631 case OP_AGGREGATE:
10632 case OP_OTHERS:
10633 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
10634 case OP_POSITIONAL:
10635 case OP_CHOICES:
10636 break;
10637
10638 case OP_NAME:
10639 case OP_STRING:
10640 {
10641 char *name = &exp->elts[elt + 2].string;
10642 int len = longest_to_int (exp->elts[elt + 1].longconst);
10643 fprintf_filtered (stream, "Text: `%.*s'", len, name);
10644 break;
10645 }
10646
10647 default:
10648 return dump_subexp_body_standard (exp, stream, elt);
10649 }
10650
10651 elt += oplen;
10652 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1)
10653 elt = dump_subexp (exp, stream, elt);
10654
10655 return elt;
10656 }
10657
10658 /* The Ada extension of print_subexp (q.v.). */
10659
10660 static void
10661 ada_print_subexp (struct expression *exp, int *pos,
10662 struct ui_file *stream, enum precedence prec)
10663 {
10664 int oplen, nargs, i;
10665 int pc = *pos;
10666 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[pc].opcode;
10667
10668 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs);
10669
10670 *pos += oplen;
10671 switch (op)
10672 {
10673 default:
10674 *pos -= oplen;
10675 print_subexp_standard (exp, pos, stream, prec);
10676 return;
10677
10678 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
10679 fputs_filtered (SYMBOL_NATURAL_NAME (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol), stream);
10680 return;
10681
10682 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
10683 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */
10684 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
10685 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream);
10686 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
10687 fputs_filtered ("'range", stream);
10688 if (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst > 1)
10689 fprintf_filtered (stream, "(%ld)",
10690 (long) exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
10691 return;
10692
10693 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
10694 if (prec >= PREC_EQUAL)
10695 fputs_filtered ("(", stream);
10696 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */
10697 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
10698 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream);
10699 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_EQUAL);
10700 fputs_filtered (" .. ", stream);
10701 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_EQUAL);
10702 if (prec >= PREC_EQUAL)
10703 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
10704 return;
10705
10706 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
10707 case OP_ATR_LAST:
10708 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
10709 case OP_ATR_IMAGE:
10710 case OP_ATR_MAX:
10711 case OP_ATR_MIN:
10712 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
10713 case OP_ATR_POS:
10714 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
10715 case OP_ATR_TAG:
10716 case OP_ATR_VAL:
10717 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_TYPE)
10718 {
10719 if (TYPE_CODE (exp->elts[*pos + 1].type) != TYPE_CODE_VOID)
10720 LA_PRINT_TYPE (exp->elts[*pos + 1].type, "", stream, 0, 0);
10721 *pos += 3;
10722 }
10723 else
10724 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
10725 fprintf_filtered (stream, "'%s", ada_attribute_name (op));
10726 if (nargs > 1)
10727 {
10728 int tem;
10729 for (tem = 1; tem < nargs; tem += 1)
10730 {
10731 fputs_filtered ((tem == 1) ? " (" : ", ", stream);
10732 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_ABOVE_COMMA);
10733 }
10734 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
10735 }
10736 return;
10737
10738 case UNOP_QUAL:
10739 type_print (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, "", stream, 0);
10740 fputs_filtered ("'(", stream);
10741 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_PREFIX);
10742 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
10743 return;
10744
10745 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
10746 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */
10747 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
10748 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream);
10749 LA_PRINT_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, "", stream, 1, 0);
10750 return;
10751
10752 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
10753 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
10754 fputs_filtered ("..", stream);
10755 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
10756 return;
10757
10758 case OP_OTHERS:
10759 fputs_filtered ("others => ", stream);
10760 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
10761 return;
10762
10763 case OP_CHOICES:
10764 for (i = 0; i < nargs-1; i += 1)
10765 {
10766 if (i > 0)
10767 fputs_filtered ("|", stream);
10768 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
10769 }
10770 fputs_filtered (" => ", stream);
10771 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
10772 return;
10773
10774 case OP_POSITIONAL:
10775 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
10776 return;
10777
10778 case OP_AGGREGATE:
10779 fputs_filtered ("(", stream);
10780 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1)
10781 {
10782 if (i > 0)
10783 fputs_filtered (", ", stream);
10784 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
10785 }
10786 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
10787 return;
10788 }
10789 }
10790
10791 /* Table mapping opcodes into strings for printing operators
10792 and precedences of the operators. */
10793
10794 static const struct op_print ada_op_print_tab[] = {
10795 {":=", BINOP_ASSIGN, PREC_ASSIGN, 1},
10796 {"or else", BINOP_LOGICAL_OR, PREC_LOGICAL_OR, 0},
10797 {"and then", BINOP_LOGICAL_AND, PREC_LOGICAL_AND, 0},
10798 {"or", BINOP_BITWISE_IOR, PREC_BITWISE_IOR, 0},
10799 {"xor", BINOP_BITWISE_XOR, PREC_BITWISE_XOR, 0},
10800 {"and", BINOP_BITWISE_AND, PREC_BITWISE_AND, 0},
10801 {"=", BINOP_EQUAL, PREC_EQUAL, 0},
10802 {"/=", BINOP_NOTEQUAL, PREC_EQUAL, 0},
10803 {"<=", BINOP_LEQ, PREC_ORDER, 0},
10804 {">=", BINOP_GEQ, PREC_ORDER, 0},
10805 {">", BINOP_GTR, PREC_ORDER, 0},
10806 {"<", BINOP_LESS, PREC_ORDER, 0},
10807 {">>", BINOP_RSH, PREC_SHIFT, 0},
10808 {"<<", BINOP_LSH, PREC_SHIFT, 0},
10809 {"+", BINOP_ADD, PREC_ADD, 0},
10810 {"-", BINOP_SUB, PREC_ADD, 0},
10811 {"&", BINOP_CONCAT, PREC_ADD, 0},
10812 {"*", BINOP_MUL, PREC_MUL, 0},
10813 {"/", BINOP_DIV, PREC_MUL, 0},
10814 {"rem", BINOP_REM, PREC_MUL, 0},
10815 {"mod", BINOP_MOD, PREC_MUL, 0},
10816 {"**", BINOP_EXP, PREC_REPEAT, 0},
10817 {"@", BINOP_REPEAT, PREC_REPEAT, 0},
10818 {"-", UNOP_NEG, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
10819 {"+", UNOP_PLUS, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
10820 {"not ", UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
10821 {"not ", UNOP_COMPLEMENT, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
10822 {"abs ", UNOP_ABS, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
10823 {".all", UNOP_IND, PREC_SUFFIX, 1},
10824 {"'access", UNOP_ADDR, PREC_SUFFIX, 1},
10825 {"'size", OP_ATR_SIZE, PREC_SUFFIX, 1},
10826 {NULL, 0, 0, 0}
10827 };
10828 \f
10829 enum ada_primitive_types {
10830 ada_primitive_type_int,
10831 ada_primitive_type_long,
10832 ada_primitive_type_short,
10833 ada_primitive_type_char,
10834 ada_primitive_type_float,
10835 ada_primitive_type_double,
10836 ada_primitive_type_void,
10837 ada_primitive_type_long_long,
10838 ada_primitive_type_long_double,
10839 ada_primitive_type_natural,
10840 ada_primitive_type_positive,
10841 ada_primitive_type_system_address,
10842 nr_ada_primitive_types
10843 };
10844
10845 static void
10846 ada_language_arch_info (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
10847 struct language_arch_info *lai)
10848 {
10849 const struct builtin_type *builtin = builtin_type (gdbarch);
10850 lai->primitive_type_vector
10851 = GDBARCH_OBSTACK_CALLOC (gdbarch, nr_ada_primitive_types + 1,
10852 struct type *);
10853 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_int] =
10854 init_type (TYPE_CODE_INT,
10855 gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT,
10856 0, "integer", (struct objfile *) NULL);
10857 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long] =
10858 init_type (TYPE_CODE_INT,
10859 gdbarch_long_bit (gdbarch) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT,
10860 0, "long_integer", (struct objfile *) NULL);
10861 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_short] =
10862 init_type (TYPE_CODE_INT,
10863 gdbarch_short_bit (gdbarch) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT,
10864 0, "short_integer", (struct objfile *) NULL);
10865 lai->string_char_type =
10866 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_char] =
10867 init_type (TYPE_CODE_INT, TARGET_CHAR_BIT / TARGET_CHAR_BIT,
10868 0, "character", (struct objfile *) NULL);
10869 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_float] =
10870 init_type (TYPE_CODE_FLT,
10871 gdbarch_float_bit (gdbarch)/ TARGET_CHAR_BIT,
10872 0, "float", (struct objfile *) NULL);
10873 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_double] =
10874 init_type (TYPE_CODE_FLT,
10875 gdbarch_double_bit (gdbarch) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT,
10876 0, "long_float", (struct objfile *) NULL);
10877 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long_long] =
10878 init_type (TYPE_CODE_INT,
10879 gdbarch_long_long_bit (gdbarch) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT,
10880 0, "long_long_integer", (struct objfile *) NULL);
10881 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long_double] =
10882 init_type (TYPE_CODE_FLT,
10883 gdbarch_double_bit (gdbarch) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT,
10884 0, "long_long_float", (struct objfile *) NULL);
10885 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_natural] =
10886 init_type (TYPE_CODE_INT,
10887 gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT,
10888 0, "natural", (struct objfile *) NULL);
10889 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_positive] =
10890 init_type (TYPE_CODE_INT,
10891 gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT,
10892 0, "positive", (struct objfile *) NULL);
10893 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_void] = builtin->builtin_void;
10894
10895 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_system_address] =
10896 lookup_pointer_type (init_type (TYPE_CODE_VOID, 1, 0, "void",
10897 (struct objfile *) NULL));
10898 TYPE_NAME (lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_system_address])
10899 = "system__address";
10900 }
10901 \f
10902 /* Language vector */
10903
10904 /* Not really used, but needed in the ada_language_defn. */
10905
10906 static void
10907 emit_char (int c, struct ui_file *stream, int quoter)
10908 {
10909 ada_emit_char (c, stream, quoter, 1);
10910 }
10911
10912 static int
10913 parse (void)
10914 {
10915 warnings_issued = 0;
10916 return ada_parse ();
10917 }
10918
10919 static const struct exp_descriptor ada_exp_descriptor = {
10920 ada_print_subexp,
10921 ada_operator_length,
10922 ada_op_name,
10923 ada_dump_subexp_body,
10924 ada_evaluate_subexp
10925 };
10926
10927 const struct language_defn ada_language_defn = {
10928 "ada", /* Language name */
10929 language_ada,
10930 range_check_off,
10931 type_check_off,
10932 case_sensitive_on, /* Yes, Ada is case-insensitive, but
10933 that's not quite what this means. */
10934 array_row_major,
10935 &ada_exp_descriptor,
10936 parse,
10937 ada_error,
10938 resolve,
10939 ada_printchar, /* Print a character constant */
10940 ada_printstr, /* Function to print string constant */
10941 emit_char, /* Function to print single char (not used) */
10942 ada_print_type, /* Print a type using appropriate syntax */
10943 ada_val_print, /* Print a value using appropriate syntax */
10944 ada_value_print, /* Print a top-level value */
10945 NULL, /* Language specific skip_trampoline */
10946 NULL, /* name_of_this */
10947 ada_lookup_symbol_nonlocal, /* Looking up non-local symbols. */
10948 basic_lookup_transparent_type, /* lookup_transparent_type */
10949 ada_la_decode, /* Language specific symbol demangler */
10950 NULL, /* Language specific class_name_from_physname */
10951 ada_op_print_tab, /* expression operators for printing */
10952 0, /* c-style arrays */
10953 1, /* String lower bound */
10954 ada_get_gdb_completer_word_break_characters,
10955 ada_make_symbol_completion_list,
10956 ada_language_arch_info,
10957 ada_print_array_index,
10958 default_pass_by_reference,
10959 LANG_MAGIC
10960 };
10961
10962 void
10963 _initialize_ada_language (void)
10964 {
10965 add_language (&ada_language_defn);
10966
10967 varsize_limit = 65536;
10968
10969 obstack_init (&symbol_list_obstack);
10970
10971 decoded_names_store = htab_create_alloc
10972 (256, htab_hash_string, (int (*)(const void *, const void *)) streq,
10973 NULL, xcalloc, xfree);
10974
10975 observer_attach_executable_changed (ada_executable_changed_observer);
10976 }